[Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
1. Introduction Autoconf's purpose, strengths, and weaknesses 2. The GNU Build System A set of tools for portable software packages 3. Making configure
ScriptsHow to organize and produce Autoconf scripts 4. Initialization and Output Files Initialization and output 5. Existing Tests Macros that check for particular features 6. Writing Tests How to write new feature checks 7. Results of Tests What to do with results from feature checks 8. Programming in M4 Layers on top of which Autoconf is written 9. Writing Autoconf Macros Adding new macros to Autoconf 10. Portable Shell Programming Shell script portability pitfalls 11. Manual Configuration Selecting features that can't be guessed 12. Site Configuration Local defaults for configure
13. Running configure
ScriptsHow to use the Autoconf output 14. Recreating a Configuration Recreating a configuration 15. Obsolete Constructs Kept for backward compatibility 16. Generating Test Suites with Autotest Creating portable test suites 17. Frequent Autoconf Questions, with answers 18. History of Autoconf A. Copying This Manual How to make copies of this manual B. Indices Indices of symbols, concepts, etc.
-- The Detailed Node Listing ---
The GNU Build System
2.1 Automake Escaping Makefile hell 2.2 Libtool Building libraries portably 2.3 Pointers More info on the GNU build system
Makingconfigure
Scripts
3.1 Writing `configure.ac' What to put in an Autoconf input file 3.2 Using autoscan
to Create `configure.ac'Semi-automatic `configure.ac' writing 3.3 Using ifnames
to List ConditionalsListing the conditionals in source code 3.4 Using autoconf
to Createconfigure
How to create configuration scripts 3.5 Using autoreconf
to Updateconfigure
ScriptsRemaking multiple configure
scripts
Writing `configure.ac'
3.1.1 A Shell Script Compiler Autoconf as solution of a problem 3.1.2 The Autoconf Language Programming in Autoconf 3.1.3 Standard `configure.ac' Layout Standard organization of `configure.ac'
Initialization and Output Files
4.1 Initializing configure
Option processing etc. 4.2 Notices in configure
Copyright, version numbers in configure
4.3 Finding configure
InputWhere Autoconf should find files 4.4 Outputting Files Outputting results from the configuration 4.5 Performing Configuration Actions Preparing the output based on results 4.6 Creating Configuration Files Creating output files 4.7 Substitutions in Makefiles Using output variables in `Makefile's 4.8 Configuration Header Files Creating a configuration header file 4.9 Running Arbitrary Configuration Commands Running arbitrary instantiation commands 4.10 Creating Configuration Links Links depending on the configuration 4.11 Configuring Other Packages in Subdirectories Configuring independent packages together 4.12 Default Prefix Changing the default installation prefix
Substitutions in Makefiles
4.7.1 Preset Output Variables Output variables that are always set 4.7.2 Installation Directory Variables Other preset output variables 4.7.3 Build Directories Supporting multiple concurrent compiles 4.7.4 Automatic Remaking Makefile rules for configuring
Configuration Header Files
4.8.1 Configuration Header Templates Input for the configuration headers 4.8.2 Using autoheader
to Create `config.h.in'How to create configuration templates 4.8.3 Autoheader Macros How to specify CPP templates
Existing Tests
5.1 Common Behavior Macros' standard schemes 5.2 Alternative Programs Selecting between alternative programs 5.3 Files Checking for the existence of files 5.4 Library Files Library archives that might be missing 5.5 Library Functions C library functions that might be missing 5.6 Header Files Header files that might be missing 5.7 Declarations Declarations that may be missing 5.8 Structures Structures or members that might be missing 5.9 Types Types that might be missing 5.10 Compilers and Preprocessors Checking for compiling programs 5.11 System Services Operating system services 5.12 UNIX Variants Special kludges for specific UNIX variants
Common Behavior
5.1.1 Standard Symbols Symbols defined by the macros 5.1.2 Default Includes Includes used by the generic macros
Alternative Programs
5.2.1 Particular Program Checks Special handling to find certain programs 5.2.2 Generic Program and File Checks How to find other programs
Library Functions
5.5.1 Portability of C Functions Pitfalls with usual functions 5.5.2 Particular Function Checks Special handling to find certain functions 5.5.3 Generic Function Checks How to find other functions
Header Files
5.6.1 Portability of Headers Collected knowledge on common headers 5.6.2 Particular Header Checks Special handling to find certain headers 5.6.3 Generic Header Checks How to find other headers
Declarations
5.7.1 Particular Declaration Checks Macros to check for certain declarations 5.7.2 Generic Declaration Checks How to find other declarations
Structures
5.8.1 Particular Structure Checks Macros to check for certain structure members 5.8.2 Generic Structure Checks How to find other structure members
Types
5.9.1 Particular Type Checks Special handling to find certain types 5.9.2 Generic Type Checks How to find other types
Compilers and Preprocessors
5.10.1 Specific Compiler Characteristics Some portability issues 5.10.2 Generic Compiler Characteristics Language independent tests 5.10.3 C Compiler Characteristics Checking its characteristics 5.10.4 C++ Compiler Characteristics Likewise 5.10.5 Fortran 77 Compiler Characteristics Likewise
Writing Tests
6.1 Language Choice Selecting which language to use for testing 6.2 Writing Test Programs Forging source files for compilers 6.3 Running the Preprocessor Detecting preprocessor symbols 6.4 Running the Compiler Detecting language or header features 6.5 Running the Linker Detecting library features 6.6 Checking Run Time Behavior Testing for run-time features 6.7 Systemology A zoology of operating systems 6.8 Multiple Cases Tests for several possible values
Writing Test Programs
6.2.1 Guidelines for Test Programs General rules for writing test programs 6.2.2 Test Functions Avoiding pitfalls in test programs 6.2.3 Generating Sources Source program boilerplate
Results of Tests
7.1 Defining C Preprocessor Symbols Defining C preprocessor symbols 7.2 Setting Output Variables Replacing variables in output files 7.3 Caching Results Speeding up subsequent configure
runs7.4 Printing Messages Notifying configure
users
Caching Results
7.3.1 Cache Variable Names Shell variables used in caches 7.3.2 Cache Files Files configure
uses for caching7.3.3 Cache Checkpointing Loading and saving the cache file
Programming in M4
8.1 M4 Quotation Protecting macros from unwanted expansion 8.2 Using autom4te
The Autoconf executables backbone 8.3 Programming in M4sugar Convenient pure M4 macros 8.4 Programming in M4sh Common shell Constructs
M4 Quotation
8.1.1 Active Characters Characters that change the behavior of M4 8.1.2 One Macro Call Quotation and one macro call 8.1.3 Quotation and Nested Macros Macros calling macros 8.1.4 changequote
is EvilWorse than INTERCAL: M4 + changequote 8.1.5 Quadrigraphs Another way to escape special characters 8.1.6 Quotation Rule Of Thumb One parenthesis, one quote
Usingautom4te
8.2.1 Invoking autom4te
A GNU M4 wrapper 8.2.2 Customizing autom4te
Customizing the Autoconf package
Programming in M4sugar
8.3.1 Redefined M4 Macros M4 builtins changed in M4sugar 8.3.2 Evaluation Macros More quotation and evaluation control 8.3.3 Forbidden Patterns Catching unexpanded macros
Writing Autoconf Macros
9.1 Macro Definitions Basic format of an Autoconf macro 9.2 Macro Names What to call your new macros 9.3 Reporting Messages Notifying autoconf
users9.4 Dependencies Between Macros What to do when macros depend on other macros 9.5 Obsoleting Macros Warning about old ways of doing things 9.6 Coding Style Writing Autoconf macros à la Autoconf
Dependencies Between Macros
9.4.1 Prerequisite Macros Ensuring required information 9.4.2 Suggested Ordering Warning about possible ordering problems
Portable Shell Programming
10.1 Shellology A zoology of shells 10.2 Here-Documents Quirks and tricks 10.3 File Descriptors FDs and redirections 10.4 File System Conventions File- and pathnames 10.5 Shell Substitutions Variable and command expansions 10.6 Assignments Varying side effects of assignments 10.7 Special Shell Variables Variables you should not change 10.8 Limitations of Shell Builtins Portable use of not so portable /bin/sh 10.9 Limitations of Usual Tools Portable use of portable tools 10.10 Limitations of Make Portable Makefiles
Manual Configuration
11.1 Specifying the System Type Specifying the system type 11.2 Getting the Canonical System Type Getting the canonical system type 11.3 Using the System Type What to do with the system type
Site Configuration
12.1 Working With External Software Working with other optional software 12.2 Choosing Package Options Selecting optional features 12.3 Making Your Help Strings Look Pretty Formatting help string 12.4 Configuring Site Details Configuring site details 12.5 Transforming Program Names When Installing Changing program names when installing 12.6 Setting Site Defaults Giving configure
local defaults
Transforming Program Names When Installing
12.5.1 Transformation Options configure
options to transform names12.5.2 Transformation Examples Sample uses of transforming names 12.5.3 Transformation Rules `Makefile' uses of transforming names
Runningconfigure
Scripts
13.1 Basic Installation Instructions for typical cases 13.2 Compilers and Options Selecting compilers and optimization 13.3 Compiling For Multiple Architectures Compiling for multiple architectures at once 13.4 Installation Names Installing in different directories 13.5 Optional Features Selecting optional features 13.6 Specifying the System Type Specifying the system type 13.7 Sharing Defaults Setting site-wide defaults for configure
13.8 Defining Variables Specifying the compiler etc. 13.9 configure
InvocationChanging how configure
runs
Obsolete Constructs
15.1 Obsolete `config.status' Invocation Different calling convention 15.2 `acconfig.h' Additional entries in `config.h.in' 15.3 Using autoupdate
to Modernize `configure.ac'Automatic update of `configure.ac' 15.4 Obsolete Macros Backward compatibility macros 15.5 Upgrading From Version 1 Tips for upgrading your files 15.6 Upgrading From Version 2.13 Some fresher tips
Upgrading From Version 1
15.5.1 Changed File Names Files you might rename 15.5.2 Changed Makefiles New things to put in `Makefile.in' 15.5.3 Changed Macros Macro calls you might replace 15.5.4 Changed Results Changes in how to check test results 15.5.5 Changed Macro Writing Better ways to write your own macros
Upgrading From Version 2.13
15.6.1 Changed Quotation Broken code which used to work 15.6.2 New Macros Interaction with foreign macros 15.6.3 Hosts and Cross-Compilation Bugward compatibility kludges 15.6.4 AC_LIBOBJ
vs.LIBOBJS
LIBOBJS is a forbidden token 15.6.5 AC_FOO_IFELSE
vs.AC_TRY_FOO
A more generic scheme for testing sources
Generating Test Suites with Autotest
16.1 Using an Autotest Test Suite Autotest and the user 16.2 Writing `testsuite.at' Autotest macros 16.3 Running testsuite
ScriptsRunning testsuite
scripts16.4 Making testsuite
ScriptsUsing autom4te to create testsuite
Using an Autotest Test Suite
16.1.1 testsuite
ScriptsThe concepts of Autotest 16.1.2 Autotest Logs Their contents
Frequent Autoconf Questions, with answers
17.1 Distributing configure
ScriptsDistributing configure
scripts17.2 Why Require GNU M4? Why not use the standard M4? 17.3 How Can I Bootstrap? Autoconf and GNU M4 require each other? 17.4 Why Not Imake? Why GNU uses configure
instead of Imake17.5 How Do I #define
Installation Directories?Passing datadir
to program17.6 What is `autom4te.cache'? What is it? Can I remove it?
History of Autoconf
18.1 Genesis Prehistory and naming of configure
18.2 Exodus The plagues of M4 and Perl 18.3 Leviticus The priestly code of portability arrives 18.4 Numbers Growth and contributors 18.5 Deuteronomy Approaching the promises of easy configuration
Copying This Manual
A.1 GNU Free Documentation License License for copying this manual
Indices
B.1 Environment Variable Index Index of environment variables used B.2 Output Variable Index Index of variables set in output files B.3 Preprocessor Symbol Index Index of C preprocessor symbols defined B.4 Autoconf Macro Index Index of Autoconf macros B.5 M4 Macro Index Index of M4, M4sugar, and M4sh macros B.6 Autotest Macro Index Index of Autotest macros B.7 Program and Function Index Index of those with portability problems B.8 Concept Index General index
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
A physicist, an engineer, and a computer scientist were discussing the nature of God. ``Surely a Physicist,'' said the physicist, ``because early in the Creation, God made Light; and you know, Maxwell's equations, the dual nature of electromagnetic waves, the relativistic consequences...'' ``An Engineer!,'' said the engineer, ``because before making Light, God split the Chaos into Land and Water; it takes a hell of an engineer to handle that big amount of mud, and orderly separation of solids from liquids...'' The computer scientist shouted: ``And the Chaos, where do you think it was coming from, hmm?'' ---Anonymous
Autoconf is a tool for producing shell scripts that automatically configure software source code packages to adapt to many kinds of UNIX-like systems. The configuration scripts produced by Autoconf are independent of Autoconf when they are run, so their users do not need to have Autoconf.
The configuration scripts produced by Autoconf require no manual user intervention when run; they do not normally even need an argument specifying the system type. Instead, they individually test for the presence of each feature that the software package they are for might need. (Before each check, they print a one-line message stating what they are checking for, so the user doesn't get too bored while waiting for the script to finish.) As a result, they deal well with systems that are hybrids or customized from the more common UNIX variants. There is no need to maintain files that list the features supported by each release of each variant of UNIX.
For each software package that Autoconf is used with, it creates a configuration script from a template file that lists the system features that the package needs or can use. After the shell code to recognize and respond to a system feature has been written, Autoconf allows it to be shared by many software packages that can use (or need) that feature. If it later turns out that the shell code needs adjustment for some reason, it needs to be changed in only one place; all of the configuration scripts can be regenerated automatically to take advantage of the updated code.
The Metaconfig package is similar in purpose to Autoconf, but the scripts it produces require manual user intervention, which is quite inconvenient when configuring large source trees. Unlike Metaconfig scripts, Autoconf scripts can support cross-compiling, if some care is taken in writing them.
Autoconf does not solve all problems related to making portable software packages--for a more complete solution, it should be used in concert with other GNU build tools like Automake and Libtool. These other tools take on jobs like the creation of a portable, recursive `Makefile' with all of the standard targets, linking of shared libraries, and so on. See section 2. The GNU Build System, for more information.
Autoconf imposes some restrictions on the names of macros used with
#if
in C programs (see section B.3 Preprocessor Symbol Index).
Autoconf requires GNU M4 in order to generate the scripts. It uses features that some UNIX versions of M4, including GNU M4 1.3, do not have. You must use version 1.4 or later of GNU M4.
See section 15.5 Upgrading From Version 1, for information about upgrading from version 1. See section 18. History of Autoconf, for the story of Autoconf's development. See section 17. Frequent Autoconf Questions, with answers, for answers to some common questions about Autoconf.
See the Autoconf web page for up-to-date information, details on the mailing lists, pointers to a list of known bugs, etc.
Mail suggestions to the Autoconf mailing list.
Bug reports should be preferably submitted to the Autoconf Gnats database, or sent to the Autoconf Bugs mailing list. If possible, first check that your bug is not already solved in current development versions, and that it has not been reported yet. Be sure to include all the needed information and a short `configure.ac' that demonstrates the problem.
Autoconf's development tree is accessible via CVS; see the Autoconf web page for details. There is also a CVSweb interface to the Autoconf development tree. Patches relative to the current CVS version can be sent for review to the Autoconf Patches mailing list.
Because of its mission, Autoconf includes only a set of often-used macros that have already demonstrated their usefulness. Nevertheless, if you wish to share your macros, or find existing ones, see the Autoconf Macro Archive, which is kindly run by Peter Simons.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Autoconf solves an important problem--reliable discovery of system-specific build and run-time information--but this is only one piece of the puzzle for the development of portable software. To this end, the GNU project has developed a suite of integrated utilities to finish the job Autoconf started: the GNU build system, whose most important components are Autoconf, Automake, and Libtool. In this chapter, we introduce you to those tools, point you to sources of more information, and try to convince you to use the entire GNU build system for your software.
2.1 Automake Escaping Makefile hell 2.2 Libtool Building libraries portably 2.3 Pointers More info on the GNU build system
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
The ubiquity of make
means that a `Makefile' is almost the
only viable way to distribute automatic build rules for software, but
one quickly runs into make
's numerous limitations. Its lack of
support for automatic dependency tracking, recursive builds in
subdirectories, reliable timestamps (e.g., for network filesystems), and
so on, mean that developers must painfully (and often incorrectly)
reinvent the wheel for each project. Portability is non-trivial, thanks
to the quirks of make
on many systems. On top of all this is the
manual labor required to implement the many standard targets that users
have come to expect (make install
, make distclean
,
make uninstall
, etc.). Since you are, of course, using Autoconf,
you also have to insert repetitive code in your Makefile.in
to
recognize @CC@
, @CFLAGS@
, and other substitutions
provided by configure
. Into this mess steps Automake.
Automake allows you to specify your build needs in a Makefile.am
file with a vastly simpler and more powerful syntax than that of a plain
Makefile
, and then generates a portable Makefile.in
for
use with Autoconf. For example, the Makefile.am
to build and
install a simple "Hello world" program might look like:
bin_PROGRAMS = hello hello_SOURCES = hello.c |
The resulting Makefile.in
(~400 lines) automatically supports all
the standard targets, the substitutions provided by Autoconf, automatic
dependency tracking, VPATH
building, and so on. make
will
build the hello
program, and make install
will install it
in `/usr/local/bin' (or whatever prefix was given to
configure
, if not `/usr/local').
Automake may require that additional tools be present on the
developer's machine. For example, the Makefile.in
that
the developer works with may not be portable (e.g., it might use special
features of your compiler to automatically generate dependency
information). Running make dist
, however, produces a
`hello-1.0.tar.gz' package (or whatever the program/version is)
with a Makefile.in
that will work on any system.
The benefits of Automake increase for larger packages (especially ones with subdirectories), but even for small programs the added convenience and portability can be substantial. And that's not all....
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Very often, one wants to build not only programs, but libraries, so that other programs can benefit from the fruits of your labor. Ideally, one would like to produce shared (dynamically linked) libraries, which can be used by multiple programs without duplication on disk or in memory and can be updated independently of the linked programs. Producing shared libraries portably, however, is the stuff of nightmares--each system has its own incompatible tools, compiler flags, and magic incantations. Fortunately, GNU provides a solution: Libtool.
Libtool handles all the requirements of building shared libraries for
you, and at this time seems to be the only way to do so with any
portability. It also handles many other headaches, such as: the
interaction of Makefile
rules with the variable suffixes of
shared libraries, linking reliably with shared libraries before they are
installed by the superuser, and supplying a consistent versioning system
(so that different versions of a library can be installed or upgraded
without breaking binary compatibility). Although Libtool, like
Autoconf, can be used on its own, it is most simply utilized in
conjunction with Automake--there, Libtool is used automatically
whenever shared libraries are needed, and you need not know its syntax.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Developers who are used to the simplicity of make
for small
projects on a single system might be daunted at the prospect of
learning to use Automake and Autoconf. As your software is
distributed to more and more users, however, you will otherwise
quickly find yourself putting lots of effort into reinventing the
services that the GNU build tools provide, and making the
same mistakes that they once made and overcame. (Besides, since
you're already learning Autoconf, Automake will be a piece of cake.)
There are a number of places that you can go to for more information on the GNU build tools.
The home pages for Autoconf, Automake, and Libtool.
See section `Automake' in GNU Automake, for more information on Automake.
The book GNU Autoconf, Automake and Libtool(1) describes the complete GNU build environment. You can also find the entire book on-line at "The Goat Book" home page.
The Autoconf Developer Page maintains links to a number of Autoconf/Automake tutorials online, and also links to the Autoconf Macro Archive.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
configure
Scripts
The configuration scripts that Autoconf produces are by convention
called configure
. When run, configure
creates several
files, replacing configuration parameters in them with appropriate
values. The files that configure
creates are:
#define
directives (see section 4.8 Configuration Header Files);
configure
makes a mistake.
To create a configure
script with Autoconf, you need to write an
Autoconf input file `configure.ac' (or `configure.in') and run
autoconf
on it. If you write your own feature tests to
supplement those that come with Autoconf, you might also write files
called `aclocal.m4' and `acsite.m4'. If you use a C header
file to contain #define
directives, you might also run
autoheader
, and you will distribute the generated file
`config.h.in' with the package.
Here is a diagram showing how the files that can be used in
configuration are produced. Programs that are executed are suffixed by
`*'. Optional files are enclosed in square brackets (`[]').
autoconf
and autoheader
also read the installed Autoconf
macro files (by reading `autoconf.m4').
Files used in preparing a software package for distribution:
your source files --> [autoscan*] --> [configure.scan] --> configure.ac configure.ac --. | .------> autoconf* -----> configure [aclocal.m4] --+---+ | `-----> [autoheader*] --> [config.h.in] [acsite.m4] ---' Makefile.in -------------------------------> Makefile.in |
Files used in configuring a software package:
.-------------> [config.cache] configure* ------------+-------------> config.log | [config.h.in] -. v .-> [config.h] -. +--> config.status* -+ +--> make* Makefile.in ---' `-> Makefile ---' |
3.1 Writing `configure.ac' What to put in an Autoconf input file 3.2 Using autoscan
to Create `configure.ac'Semi-automatic `configure.ac' writing 3.3 Using ifnames
to List ConditionalsListing the conditionals in source code 3.4 Using autoconf
to Createconfigure
How to create configuration scripts 3.5 Using autoreconf
to Updateconfigure
ScriptsRemaking multiple configure
scripts
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
To produce a configure
script for a software package, create a
file called `configure.ac' that contains invocations of the
Autoconf macros that test the system features your package needs or can
use. Autoconf macros already exist to check for many features; see
5. Existing Tests, for their descriptions. For most other features,
you can use Autoconf template macros to produce custom checks; see
6. Writing Tests, for information about them. For especially tricky
or specialized features, `configure.ac' might need to contain some
hand-crafted shell commands; see 10. Portable Shell Programming. The
autoscan
program can give you a good start in writing
`configure.ac' (see section 3.2 Using autoscan
to Create `configure.ac', for more information).
Previous versions of Autoconf promoted the name `configure.in',
which is somewhat ambiguous (the tool needed to process this file is not
described by its extension), and introduces a slight confusion with
`config.h.in' and so on (for which `.in' means "to be
processed by configure
"). Using `configure.ac' is now
preferred.
3.1.1 A Shell Script Compiler Autoconf as solution of a problem 3.1.2 The Autoconf Language Programming in Autoconf 3.1.3 Standard `configure.ac' Layout Standard organization of `configure.ac'
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Just as for any other computer language, in order to properly program `configure.ac' in Autoconf you must understand what problem the language tries to address and how it does so.
The problem Autoconf addresses is that the world is a mess. After all,
you are using Autoconf in order to have your package compile easily on
all sorts of different systems, some of them being extremely hostile.
Autoconf itself bears the price for these differences: configure
must run on all those systems, and thus configure
must limit itself
to their lowest common denominator of features.
Naturally, you might then think of shell scripts; who needs
autoconf
? A set of properly written shell functions is enough to
make it easy to write configure
scripts by hand. Sigh!
Unfortunately, shell functions do not belong to the least common
denominator; therefore, where you would like to define a function and
use it ten times, you would instead need to copy its body ten times.
So, what is really needed is some kind of compiler, autoconf
,
that takes an Autoconf program, `configure.ac', and transforms it
into a portable shell script, configure
.
How does autoconf
perform this task?
There are two obvious possibilities: creating a brand new language or
extending an existing one. The former option is very attractive: all
sorts of optimizations could easily be implemented in the compiler and
many rigorous checks could be performed on the Autoconf program
(e.g., rejecting any non-portable construct). Alternatively, you can
extend an existing language, such as the sh
(Bourne shell)
language.
Autoconf does the latter: it is a layer on top of sh
. It was
therefore most convenient to implement autoconf
as a macro
expander: a program that repeatedly performs macro expansions on
text input, replacing macro calls with macro bodies and producing a pure
sh
script in the end. Instead of implementing a dedicated
Autoconf macro expander, it is natural to use an existing
general-purpose macro language, such as M4, and implement the extensions
as a set of M4 macros.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
The Autoconf language is very different from many other computer languages because it treats actual code the same as plain text. Whereas in C, for instance, data and instructions have very different syntactic status, in Autoconf their status is rigorously the same. Therefore, we need a means to distinguish literal strings from text to be expanded: quotation.
When calling macros that take arguments, there must not be any blank space between the macro name and the open parenthesis. Arguments should be enclosed within the M4 quote characters `[' and `]', and be separated by commas. Any leading spaces in arguments are ignored, unless they are quoted. You may safely leave out the quotes when the argument is simple text, but always quote complex arguments such as other macro calls. This rule applies recursively for every macro call, including macros called from other macros.
For instance:
AC_CHECK_HEADER([stdio.h], [AC_DEFINE([HAVE_STDIO_H])], [AC_MSG_ERROR([Sorry, can't do anything for you])]) |
is quoted properly. You may safely simplify its quotation to:
AC_CHECK_HEADER(stdio.h, [AC_DEFINE(HAVE_STDIO_H)], [AC_MSG_ERROR([Sorry, can't do anything for you])]) |
Notice that the argument of AC_MSG_ERROR
is still quoted;
otherwise, its comma would have been interpreted as an argument separator.
The following example is wrong and dangerous, as it is underquoted:
AC_CHECK_HEADER(stdio.h, AC_DEFINE(HAVE_STDIO_H), AC_MSG_ERROR([Sorry, can't do anything for you])) |
In other cases, you may have to use text that also resembles a macro call. You must quote that text even when it is not passed as a macro argument:
echo "Hard rock was here! --[AC_DC]" |
which will result in
echo "Hard rock was here! --AC_DC" |
When you use the same text in a macro argument, you must therefore have an extra quotation level (since one is stripped away by the macro substitution). In general, then, it is a good idea to use double quoting for all literal string arguments:
AC_MSG_WARN([[AC_DC stinks --Iron Maiden]]) |
You are now able to understand one of the constructs of Autoconf that has been continually misunderstood... The rule of thumb is that whenever you expect macro expansion, expect quote expansion; i.e., expect one level of quotes to be lost. For instance:
AC_COMPILE_IFELSE([char b[10];],, [AC_MSG_ERROR([you lose])]) |
is incorrect: here, the first argument of AC_COMPILE_IFELSE
is
`char b[10];' and will be expanded once, which results in
`char b10;'. (There was an idiom common in Autoconf's past to
address this issue via the M4 changequote
primitive, but do not
use it!) Let's take a closer look: the author meant the first argument
to be understood as a literal, and therefore it must be quoted twice:
AC_COMPILE_IFELSE([[char b[10];]],, [AC_MSG_ERROR([you lose])]) |
Voilà, you actually produce `char b[10];' this time!
The careful reader will notice that, according to these guidelines, the
"properly" quoted AC_CHECK_HEADER
example above is actually
lacking three pairs of quotes! Nevertheless, for the sake of readability,
double quotation of literals is used only where needed in this manual.
Some macros take optional arguments, which this documentation represents as [arg] (not to be confused with the quote characters). You may just leave them empty, or use `[]' to make the emptiness of the argument explicit, or you may simply omit the trailing commas. The three lines below are equivalent:
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(stdio.h, [], [], []) AC_CHECK_HEADERS(stdio.h,,,) AC_CHECK_HEADERS(stdio.h) |
It is best to put each macro call on its own line in
`configure.ac'. Most of the macros don't add extra newlines; they
rely on the newline after the macro call to terminate the commands.
This approach makes the generated configure
script a little
easier to read by not inserting lots of blank lines. It is generally
safe to set shell variables on the same line as a macro call, because
the shell allows assignments without intervening newlines.
You can include comments in `configure.ac' files by starting them with the `#'. For example, it is helpful to begin `configure.ac' files with a line like this:
# Process this file with autoconf to produce a configure script. |
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
The order in which `configure.ac' calls the Autoconf macros is not
important, with a few exceptions. Every `configure.ac' must
contain a call to AC_INIT
before the checks, and a call to
AC_OUTPUT
at the end (see section 4.4 Outputting Files). Additionally, some macros
rely on other macros having been called first, because they check
previously set values of some variables to decide what to do. These
macros are noted in the individual descriptions (see section 5. Existing Tests), and they also warn you when configure
is created if they
are called out of order.
To encourage consistency, here is a suggested order for calling the Autoconf macros. Generally speaking, the things near the end of this list are those that could depend on things earlier in it. For example, library functions could be affected by types and libraries.
Autoconf requirements |
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
autoscan
to Create `configure.ac'
The autoscan
program can help you create and/or maintain a
`configure.ac' file for a software package. autoscan
examines source files in the directory tree rooted at a directory given
as a command line argument, or the current directory if none is given.
It searches the source files for common portability problems and creates
a file `configure.scan' which is a preliminary `configure.ac'
for that package, and checks a possibly existing `configure.ac' for
completeness.
When using autoscan
to create a `configure.ac', you
should manually examine `configure.scan' before renaming it to
`configure.ac'; it will probably need some adjustments.
Occasionally, autoscan
outputs a macro in the wrong order
relative to another macro, so that autoconf
produces a warning;
you need to move such macros manually. Also, if you want the package to
use a configuration header file, you must add a call to
AC_CONFIG_HEADERS
(see section 4.8 Configuration Header Files). You might
also have to change or add some #if
directives to your program in
order to make it work with Autoconf (see section 3.3 Using ifnames
to List Conditionals, for
information about a program that can help with that job).
When using autoscan
to maintain a `configure.ac', simply
consider adding its suggestions. The file `autoscan.log' will
contain detailed information on why a macro is requested.
autoscan
uses several data files (installed along with Autoconf)
to determine which macros to output when it finds particular symbols in
a package's source files. These data files all have the same format:
each line consists of a symbol, whitespace, and the Autoconf macro to
output if that symbol is encountered. Lines starting with `#' are
comments.
autoscan
accepts the following options:
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
ifnames
to List Conditionals
ifnames
can help you write `configure.ac' for a software
package. It prints the identifiers that the package already uses in C
preprocessor conditionals. If a package has already been set up to have
some portability, ifnames
can thus help you figure out what its
configure
needs to check for. It may help fill in some gaps in a
`configure.ac' generated by autoscan
(see section 3.2 Using autoscan
to Create `configure.ac').
ifnames
scans all of the C source files named on the command line
(or the standard input, if none are given) and writes to the standard
output a sorted list of all the identifiers that appear in those files
in #if
, #elif
, #ifdef
, or #ifndef
directives. It prints each identifier on a line, followed by a
space-separated list of the files in which that identifier occurs.
ifnames
accepts the following options:
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
autoconf
to Create configure
To create configure
from `configure.ac', run the
autoconf
program with no arguments. autoconf
processes
`configure.ac' with the M4 macro processor, using the
Autoconf macros. If you give autoconf
an argument, it reads that
file instead of `configure.ac' and writes the configuration script
to the standard output instead of to configure
. If you give
autoconf
the argument `-', it reads from the standard
input instead of `configure.ac' and writes the configuration script
to the standard output.
The Autoconf macros are defined in several files. Some of the files are
distributed with Autoconf; autoconf
reads them first. Then it
looks for the optional file `acsite.m4' in the directory that
contains the distributed Autoconf macro files, and for the optional file
`aclocal.m4' in the current directory. Those files can contain
your site's or the package's own Autoconf macro definitions
(see section 9. Writing Autoconf Macros, for more information). If a macro is
defined in more than one of the files that autoconf
reads, the
last definition it reads overrides the earlier ones.
autoconf
accepts the following options:
AC_DIAGNOSE
, for a comprehensive list of categories. Special
values include:
Warnings about `syntax' are enabled by default, and the environment
variable WARNINGS
, a comma separated list of categories, is
honored. Passing `-W category' will actually behave as if
you had passed `--warnings=syntax,$WARNINGS,category'. If
you want to disable the defaults and WARNINGS
, but (for example)
enable the warnings about obsolete constructs, you would use `-W
none,obsolete'.
Because autoconf
uses autom4te
behind the scenes, it
displays a back trace for errors, but not for warnings; if you want
them, just pass `-W error'. See section 8.2.1 Invoking autom4te
, for some
examples.
configure
script, but list the calls to
macro according to the format. Multiple `--trace'
arguments can be used to list several macros. Multiple `--trace'
arguments for a single macro are not cumulative; instead, you should
just make format as long as needed.
The format is a regular string, with newlines if desired, and
several special escape codes. It defaults to `$f:$l:$n:$%'; see
8.2.1 Invoking autom4te
, for details on the format.
AC_DEFUN
definitions). This
results in a noticeable speedup, but can be disabled by this option.
It is often necessary to check the content of a `configure.ac' file, but parsing it yourself is extremely fragile and error-prone. It is suggested that you rely upon `--trace' to scan `configure.ac'. For instance, to find the list of variables that are substituted, use:
$ autoconf -t AC_SUBST configure.ac:2:AC_SUBST:ECHO_C configure.ac:2:AC_SUBST:ECHO_N configure.ac:2:AC_SUBST:ECHO_T More traces deleted |
The example below highlights the difference between `$@', `$*', and $%.
$ cat configure.ac AC_DEFINE(This, is, [an [example]]) $ autoconf -t 'AC_DEFINE:@: $@ *: $* $: $%' @: [This],[is],[an [example]] *: This,is,an [example] $: This:is:an [example] |
The format gives you a lot of freedom:
$ autoconf -t 'AC_SUBST:$$ac_subst{"$1"} = "$f:$l";' $ac_subst{"ECHO_C"} = "configure.ac:2"; $ac_subst{"ECHO_N"} = "configure.ac:2"; $ac_subst{"ECHO_T"} = "configure.ac:2"; More traces deleted |
A long separator can be used to improve the readability of complex structures, and to ease their parsing (for instance when no single character is suitable as a separator):
$ autoconf -t 'AM_MISSING_PROG:${|:::::|}*' ACLOCAL|:::::|aclocal|:::::|$missing_dir AUTOCONF|:::::|autoconf|:::::|$missing_dir AUTOMAKE|:::::|automake|:::::|$missing_dir More traces deleted |
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
autoreconf
to Update configure
Scripts
Installing the various components of the GNU Build System can be
tedious: running autopoint
for Gettext, automake
for
`Makefile.in' etc. in each directory. It may be needed either
because some tools such as automake
have been updated on your
system, or because some of the sources such as `configure.ac' have
been updated, or finally, simply in order to install the GNU Build
System in a fresh tree.
autoreconf
runs autoconf
, autoheader
,
aclocal
, automake
, libtoolize
, and
autopoint
(when appropriate) repeatedly to update the
GNU Build System in the specified directories and their
subdirectories (see section 4.11 Configuring Other Packages in Subdirectories). By default, it only remakes
those files that are older than their sources.
If you install a new version of some tool, you can make
autoreconf
remake all of the files by giving it the
`--force' option.
See section 4.7.4 Automatic Remaking, for `Makefile' rules to automatically
remake configure
scripts when their source files change. That
method handles the timestamps of configuration header templates
properly, but does not pass `--autoconf-dir=dir' or
`--localdir=dir'.
autoreconf
accepts the following options:
autoreconf
runs
autoconf
(and autoheader
, if appropriate).
This option triggers calls to `automake --add-missing', `libtoolize', `autopoint', etc.
Warnings about `syntax' are enabled by default, and the environment
variable WARNINGS
, a comma separated list of categories, is
honored. Passing `-W category' will actually behave as if
you had passed `--warnings=syntax,$WARNINGS,category'. If
you want to disable the defaults and WARNINGS
, but (for example)
enable the warnings about obsolete constructs, you would use `-W
none,obsolete'.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Autoconf-generated configure
scripts need some information about
how to initialize, such as how to find the package's source files and
about the output files to produce. The following sections describe the
initialization and the creation of output files.
4.1 Initializing configure
Option processing etc. 4.2 Notices in configure
Copyright, version numbers in configure
4.3 Finding configure
InputWhere Autoconf should find files 4.4 Outputting Files Outputting results from the configuration 4.5 Performing Configuration Actions Preparing the output based on results 4.6 Creating Configuration Files Creating output files 4.7 Substitutions in Makefiles Using output variables in `Makefile's 4.8 Configuration Header Files Creating a configuration header file 4.9 Running Arbitrary Configuration Commands Running arbitrary instantiation commands 4.10 Creating Configuration Links Links depending on the configuration 4.11 Configuring Other Packages in Subdirectories Configuring independent packages together 4.12 Default Prefix Changing the default installation prefix
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
configure
Every configure
script must call AC_INIT
before doing
anything else. The only other required macro is AC_OUTPUT
(see section 4.4 Outputting Files).
Set the name of the package and its version. These are
typically used in `--version' support, including that of
configure
. The optional argument bug-report should be
the email to which users should send bug reports. The package
tarname differs from package: the latter designates the full
package name (e.g., `GNU Autoconf'), while the former is meant for
distribution tar ball names (e.g., `autoconf'). It defaults to
package with `GNU ' stripped, lower-cased, and all characters
other than alphanumerics and underscores are changed to `-'.
It is preferable that the arguments of AC_INIT
be static, i.e.,
there should not be any shell computation, but they can be computed by
M4.
The following M4 macros (e.g., AC_PACKAGE_NAME
), output variables
(e.g., PACKAGE_NAME
), and preprocessor symbols (e.g.,
PACKAGE_NAME
) are defined by AC_INIT
:
AC_PACKAGE_NAME
, PACKAGE_NAME
AC_PACKAGE_TARNAME
, PACKAGE_TARNAME
AC_PACKAGE_VERSION
, PACKAGE_VERSION
AC_PACKAGE_STRING
, PACKAGE_STRING
AC_PACKAGE_BUGREPORT
, PACKAGE_BUGREPORT
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
configure
The following macros manage version numbers for configure
scripts. Using them is optional.
configure
is earlier
than version, print an error message to the standard error output
and do not create configure
. For example:
AC_PREREQ(2.57) |
This macro is the only macro that may be used before AC_INIT
, but
for consistency, you are invited not to do so.
configure
are covered by the
copyright-notice.
The copyright-notice will show up in both the head of
configure
and in `configure --version'.
configure
script, with any dollar signs or double-quotes removed. This macro lets
you put a revision stamp from `configure.ac' into configure
without RCS or CVS changing it when you check in
configure
. That way, you can determine easily which revision of
`configure.ac' a particular configure
corresponds to.
For example, this line in `configure.ac':
AC_REVISION($Revision: 1.30 $) |
produces this in configure
:
#! /bin/sh # From configure.ac Revision: 1.30 |
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
configure
Input configure
checks for this file's existence to
make sure that the directory that it is told contains the source code in
fact does. Occasionally people accidentally specify the wrong directory
with `--srcdir'; this is a safety check. See section 13.9 configure
Invocation, for more information.
Packages that do manual configuration or use the install
program
might need to tell configure
where to find some other shell
scripts by calling AC_CONFIG_AUX_DIR
, though the default places
it looks are correct for most cases.
configure
,
Automake and Libtool scripts etc.) that are in directory dir.
These are auxiliary files used in configuration. dir can be
either absolute or relative to `srcdir'. The default is
`srcdir' or `srcdir/..' or
`srcdir/../..', whichever is the first that contains
`install-sh'. The other files are not checked for, so that using
AC_PROG_INSTALL
does not automatically require distributing the
other auxiliary files. It checks for `install.sh' also, but that
name is obsolete because some make
have a rule that creates
`install' from it if there is no `Makefile'.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Every Autoconf script, e.g., `configure.ac', should finish by
calling AC_OUTPUT
. That is the macro that generates
`config.status', which will create the `Makefile's and any
other files resulting from configuration. This is the only required
macro besides AC_INIT
(see section 4.3 Finding configure
Input).
`config.status' will perform all the configuration actions: all the
output files (see 4.6 Creating Configuration Files, macro
AC_CONFIG_FILES
), header files (see 4.8 Configuration Header Files,
macro AC_CONFIG_HEADERS
), commands (see 4.9 Running Arbitrary Configuration Commands, macro AC_CONFIG_COMMANDS
), links (see
4.10 Creating Configuration Links, macro AC_CONFIG_LINKS
), subdirectories
to configure (see 4.11 Configuring Other Packages in Subdirectories, macro AC_CONFIG_SUBDIRS
)
are honored.
Historically, the usage of AC_OUTPUT
was somewhat different.
See section 15.4 Obsolete Macros, for a description of the arguments that
AC_OUTPUT
used to support.
If you run make
in subdirectories, you should run it using the
make
variable MAKE
. Most versions of make
set
MAKE
to the name of the make
program plus any options it
was given. (But many do not include in it the values of any variables
set on the command line, so those are not passed on automatically.)
Some old versions of make
do not set this variable. The
following macro allows you to use it even with those versions.
make
predefines the Make variable MAKE
, define
output variable SET_MAKE
to be empty. Otherwise, define
SET_MAKE
to contain `MAKE=make'. Calls AC_SUBST
for
SET_MAKE
.
If you use this macro, place a line like this in each `Makefile.in'
that runs MAKE
on other directories:
@SET_MAKE@ |
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
`configure' is designed so that it appears to do everything itself, but there is actually a hidden slave: `config.status'. `configure' is in charge of examining your system, but it is `config.status' that actually takes the proper actions based on the results of `configure'. The most typical task of `config.status' is to instantiate files.
This section describes the common behavior of the four standard
instantiating macros: AC_CONFIG_FILES
, AC_CONFIG_HEADERS
,
AC_CONFIG_COMMANDS
and AC_CONFIG_LINKS
. They all
have this prototype:
AC_CONFIG_FOOS(tag..., [commands], [init-cmds]) |
where the arguments are:
You are encouraged to use literals as tags. In particular, you should avoid
... && my_foos="$my_foos fooo" ... && my_foos="$my_foos foooo" AC_CONFIG_FOOS($my_foos) |
and use this instead:
... && AC_CONFIG_FOOS(fooo) ... && AC_CONFIG_FOOS(foooo) |
The macros AC_CONFIG_FILES
and AC_CONFIG_HEADERS
use
special tags: they may have the form `output' or
`output:inputs'. The file output is instantiated
from its templates, inputs (defaulting to `output.in').
For instance `AC_CONFIG_FILES(Makefile:boiler/top.mk:boiler/bot.mk)' asks for the creation of `Makefile' that will be the expansion of the output variables in the concatenation of `boiler/top.mk' and `boiler/bot.mk'.
The special value `-' might be used to denote the standard output when used in output, or the standard input when used in the inputs. You most probably don't need to use this in `configure.ac', but it is convenient when using the command line interface of `./config.status', see 14. Recreating a Configuration, for more details.
The inputs may be absolute or relative filenames. In the latter case they are first looked for in the build tree, and then in the source tree.
The variables set during the execution of configure
are
not available here: you first need to set them via the
init-cmds. Nonetheless the following variables are precomputed:
srcdir
configure
's option `--srcdir' sets.
ac_top_srcdir
ac_top_builddir
ac_srcdir
The current directory refers to the directory (or pseudo-directory) containing the input part of tags. For instance, running
AC_CONFIG_COMMANDS([deep/dir/out:in/in.in], [...], [...]) |
with `--srcdir=../package' produces the following values:
# Argument of --srcdir srcdir='../package' # Reversing deep/dir ac_top_builddir='../../' # Concatenation of $ac_top_builddir and srcdir ac_top_srcdir='../../../package' # Concatenation of $ac_top_srcdir and deep/dir ac_srcdir='../../../package/deep/dir' |
independently of `in/in.in'.
var
. init-cmds
is typically used by `configure' to give `config.status' some
variables it needs to run the commands.
You should be extremely cautious in your variable names: all the init-cmds share the same name space and may overwrite each other in unpredictable ways. Sorry....
All these macros can be called multiple times, with different tags, of course!
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Be sure to read the previous section, 4.5 Performing Configuration Actions.
AC_OUTPUT
create each `file' by copying an input
file (by default `file.in'), substituting the output variable
values.
This macro is one of the instantiating macros; see 4.5 Performing Configuration Actions. See section 4.7 Substitutions in Makefiles, for more information on using
output variables. See section 7.2 Setting Output Variables, for more information
on creating them. This macro creates the directory that the file is in
if it doesn't exist. Usually, `Makefile's are created this way,
but other files, such as `.gdbinit', can be specified as well.
Typical calls to AC_CONFIG_FILES
look like this:
AC_CONFIG_FILES([Makefile src/Makefile man/Makefile X/Imakefile]) AC_CONFIG_FILES([autoconf], [chmod +x autoconf]) |
You can override an input file name by appending to file a colon-separated list of input files. Examples:
AC_CONFIG_FILES([Makefile:boiler/top.mk:boiler/bot.mk] [lib/Makefile:boiler/lib.mk]) |
Doing this allows you to keep your file names acceptable to MS-DOS, or to prepend and/or append boilerplate to the file.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Each subdirectory in a distribution that contains something to be
compiled or installed should come with a file `Makefile.in', from
which configure
will create a `Makefile' in that directory.
To create a `Makefile', configure
performs a simple variable
substitution, replacing occurrences of `@variable@' in
`Makefile.in' with the value that configure
has determined
for that variable. Variables that are substituted into output files in
this way are called output variables. They are ordinary shell
variables that are set in configure
. To make configure
substitute a particular variable into the output files, the macro
AC_SUBST
must be called with that variable name as an argument.
Any occurrences of `@variable@' for other variables are
left unchanged. See section 7.2 Setting Output Variables, for more information
on creating output variables with AC_SUBST
.
A software package that uses a configure
script should be
distributed with a file `Makefile.in', but no `Makefile'; that
way, the user has to properly configure the package for the local system
before compiling it.
See section `Makefile Conventions' in The GNU Coding Standards, for more information on what to put in `Makefile's.
4.7.1 Preset Output Variables Output variables that are always set 4.7.2 Installation Directory Variables Other preset output variables 4.7.3 Build Directories Supporting multiple concurrent compiles 4.7.4 Automatic Remaking Makefile rules for configuring
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Some output variables are preset by the Autoconf macros. Some of the
Autoconf macros set additional output variables, which are mentioned in
the descriptions for those macros. See section B.2 Output Variable Index, for a
complete list of output variables. See section 4.7.2 Installation Directory Variables, for the list of the preset ones related to installation
directories. Below are listed the other preset ones. They all are
precious variables (see section 7.2 Setting Output Variables,
AC_ARG_VAR
).
configure
runs, the default value is set
when you call AC_PROG_CC
(or empty if you don't). configure
uses this variable when compiling programs to test for C features.
configure
and giving the name of the input file.
AC_OUTPUT
adds a comment line containing this variable to the top
of every `Makefile' it creates. For other files, you should
reference this variable in a comment at the top of each input file. For
example, an input shell script should begin like this:
#! /bin/sh # @configure_input@ |
The presence of that line also reminds people editing the file that it
needs to be processed by configure
in order to be used.
configure
runs, the default
value is empty. configure
uses this variable when compiling or
preprocessing programs to test for C and C++ features.
configure
runs, the default value is
set when you call AC_PROG_CXX
(or empty if you don't).
configure
uses this variable when compiling programs to test for
C++ features.
AC_CONFIG_HEADERS
is called, configure
replaces `@DEFS@' with
`-DHAVE_CONFIG_H' instead (see section 4.8 Configuration Header Files). This
variable is not defined while configure
is performing its tests,
only when creating the output files. See section 7.2 Setting Output Variables, for
how to check the results of previous tests.
echo
for
question-answer message pairs? These variables provide a way:
echo $ECHO_N "And the winner is... $ECHO_C" sleep 100000000000 echo "${ECHO_T}dead." |
Some old and uncommon echo
implementations offer no means to
achieve this, in which case ECHO_T
is set to tab. You might not
want to use it.
configure
runs, the default
value is set when you call AC_PROG_F77
(or empty if you don't).
configure
uses this variable when compiling programs to test for
Fortran 77 features.
LIBS
instead. If it is not set
in the environment when configure
runs, the default value is empty.
configure
uses this variable when linking programs to test for
C, C++ and Fortran 77 features.
configure
uses this variable when linking
programs to test for C, C++ and Fortran 77 features.
builddir
.
builddir
.
top_builddir
.
srcdir
.
srcdir
.
top_srcdir
.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
The following variables specify the directories where the package will be installed, see section `Variables for Installation Directories' in The GNU Coding Standards, for more information. See the end of this section for details on when and how to use these variables.
Most of these variables have values that rely on prefix
or
exec_prefix
. It is deliberate that the directory output
variables keep them unexpanded: typically `@datadir@' will be
replaced by `${prefix}/share', not `/usr/local/share'.
This behavior is mandated by the GNU coding standards, so that when the user runs:
configure
, in which case, if needed, the package shall hard
code dependencies corresponding to the make-specified prefix.
In order to support these features, it is essential that datadir
remains being defined as `${prefix}/share' to depend upon the
current value of prefix
.
A corollary is that you should not use these variables except in
Makefiles. For instance, instead of trying to evaluate datadir
in `configure' and hard-coding it in Makefiles using
e.g., `AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(DATADIR, "$datadir")', you should add
`-DDATADIR="$(datadir)"' to your CPPFLAGS
.
Similarly you should not rely on AC_OUTPUT_FILES
to replace
datadir
and friends in your shell scripts and other files, rather
let make
manage their replacement. For instance Autoconf
ships templates of its shell scripts ending with `.in', and uses a
Makefile snippet similar to:
edit = sed \ -e 's,@datadir\@,$(pkgdatadir),g' \ -e 's,@prefix\@,$(prefix),g' autoconf: Makefile $(srcdir)/autoconf.in rm -f autoconf autoconf.tmp $(edit) $(srcdir)/autoconf.in >autoconf.tmp chmod +x autoconf.tmp mv autoconf.tmp autoconf autoheader: Makefile $(srcdir)/autoheader.in rm -f autoheader autoheader.tmp $(edit) $(srcdir)/autoconf.in >autoheader.tmp chmod +x autoheader.tmp mv autoheader.tmp autoheader |
Some details are noteworthy:
configure
from replacing
`@datadir@' in the sed expression itself.
edit
uses values that depend on the configuration specific
values (prefix
etc.) and not only on VERSION
and so forth,
the output depends on `Makefile', not `configure.ac'.
autoconf autoheader: Makefile .in: rm -f $@ $@.tmp $(edit) $< >$@.tmp chmod +x $@.tmp mv $@.tmp $@ |
See section 10.10 Limitations of Make, for details.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
You can support compiling a software package for several architectures simultaneously from the same copy of the source code. The object files for each architecture are kept in their own directory.
To support doing this, make
uses the VPATH
variable to
find the files that are in the source directory. GNU Make
and most other recent make
programs can do this. Older
make
programs do not support VPATH
; when using them, the
source code must be in the same directory as the object files.
To support VPATH
, each `Makefile.in' should contain two
lines that look like:
srcdir = @srcdir@ VPATH = @srcdir@ |
Do not set VPATH
to the value of another variable, for example
`VPATH = $(srcdir)', because some versions of make
do not do
variable substitutions on the value of VPATH
.
configure
substitutes the correct value for srcdir
when
it produces `Makefile'.
Do not use the make
variable $<
, which expands to the
file name of the file in the source directory (found with VPATH
),
except in implicit rules. (An implicit rule is one such as `.c.o',
which tells how to create a `.o' file from a `.c' file.) Some
versions of make
do not set $<
in explicit rules; they
expand it to an empty value.
Instead, `Makefile' command lines should always refer to source files by prefixing them with `$(srcdir)/'. For example:
time.info: time.texinfo $(MAKEINFO) $(srcdir)/time.texinfo |
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
You can put rules like the following in the top-level `Makefile.in' for a package to automatically update the configuration information when you change the configuration files. This example includes all of the optional files, such as `aclocal.m4' and those related to configuration header files. Omit from the `Makefile.in' rules for any of these files that your package does not use.
The `$(srcdir)/' prefix is included because of limitations in the
VPATH
mechanism.
The `stamp-' files are necessary because the timestamps of
`config.h.in' and `config.h' will not be changed if remaking
them does not change their contents. This feature avoids unnecessary
recompilation. You should include the file `stamp-h.in' your
package's distribution, so make
will consider
`config.h.in' up to date. Don't use touch
(see section 10.9 Limitations of Usual Tools), rather use echo
(using
date
would cause needless differences, hence CVS
conflicts etc.).
$(srcdir)/configure: configure.ac aclocal.m4 cd $(srcdir) && autoconf # autoheader might not change config.h.in, so touch a stamp file. $(srcdir)/config.h.in: stamp-h.in $(srcdir)/stamp-h.in: configure.ac aclocal.m4 cd $(srcdir) && autoheader echo timestamp > $(srcdir)/stamp-h.in config.h: stamp-h stamp-h: config.h.in config.status ./config.status Makefile: Makefile.in config.status ./config.status config.status: configure ./config.status --recheck |
(Be careful if you copy these lines directly into your Makefile, as you will need to convert the indented lines to start with the tab character.)
In addition, you should use `AC_CONFIG_FILES([stamp-h], [echo
timestamp > stamp-h])' so `config.status' will ensure that
`config.h' is considered up to date. See section 4.4 Outputting Files, for more
information about AC_OUTPUT
.
See section 14. Recreating a Configuration, for more examples of handling configuration-related dependencies.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
When a package contains more than a few tests that define C preprocessor
symbols, the command lines to pass `-D' options to the compiler
can get quite long. This causes two problems. One is that the
make
output is hard to visually scan for errors. More
seriously, the command lines can exceed the length limits of some
operating systems. As an alternative to passing `-D' options to
the compiler, configure
scripts can create a C header file
containing `#define' directives. The AC_CONFIG_HEADERS
macro selects this kind of output. It should be called right after
AC_INIT
.
The package should `#include' the configuration header file before
any other header files, to prevent inconsistencies in declarations (for
example, if it redefines const
). Use `#include <config.h>'
instead of `#include "config.h"', and pass the C compiler a
`-I.' option (or `-I..'; whichever directory contains
`config.h'). That way, even if the source directory is configured
itself (perhaps to make a distribution), other build directories can
also be configured without finding the `config.h' from the source
directory.
AC_OUTPUT
create the file(s) in the
whitespace-separated list header containing C preprocessor
#define
statements, and replace `@DEFS@' in generated
files with `-DHAVE_CONFIG_H' instead of the value of DEFS
.
The usual name for header is `config.h'.
If header already exists and its contents are identical to what
AC_OUTPUT
would put in it, it is left alone. Doing this allows
making some changes in the configuration without needlessly causing
object files that depend on the header file to be recompiled.
Usually the input file is named `header.in'; however, you can override the input file name by appending to header a colon-separated list of input files. Examples:
AC_CONFIG_HEADERS([config.h:config.hin]) AC_CONFIG_HEADERS([defines.h:defs.pre:defines.h.in:defs.post]) |
Doing this allows you to keep your file names acceptable to MS-DOS, or to prepend and/or append boilerplate to the file.
See section 4.5 Performing Configuration Actions, for more details on header.
4.8.1 Configuration Header Templates Input for the configuration headers 4.8.2 Using autoheader
to Create `config.h.in'How to create configuration templates 4.8.3 Autoheader Macros How to specify CPP templates
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Your distribution should contain a template file that looks as you want
the final header file to look, including comments, with #undef
statements which are used as hooks. For example, suppose your
`configure.ac' makes these calls:
AC_CONFIG_HEADERS([conf.h]) AC_CHECK_HEADERS([unistd.h]) |
Then you could have code like the following in `conf.h.in'. On
systems that have `unistd.h', configure
will `#define'
`HAVE_UNISTD_H' to 1. On other systems, the whole line will be
commented out (in case the system predefines that symbol).
/* Define as 1 if you have unistd.h. */ #undef HAVE_UNISTD_H |
Pay attention that `#undef' is in the first column, and there is nothing behind `HAVE_UNISTD_H', not even white spaces. You can then decode the configuration header using the preprocessor directives:
#include <conf.h> #if HAVE_UNISTD_H # include <unistd.h> #else /* We are in trouble. */ #endif |
The use of old form templates, with `#define' instead of `#undef' is strongly discouraged. Similarly with old templates with comments on the same line as the `#undef'. Anyway, putting comments in preprocessor macros has never been a good idea.
Since it is a tedious task to keep a template header up to date, you may
use autoheader
to generate it, see 4.8.2 Using autoheader
to Create `config.h.in'.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
autoheader
to Create `config.h.in'
The autoheader
program can create a template file of C
`#define' statements for configure
to use. If
`configure.ac' invokes AC_CONFIG_HEADERS(file)
,
autoheader
creates `file.in'; if multiple file
arguments are given, the first one is used. Otherwise,
autoheader
creates `config.h.in'.
In order to do its job, autoheader
needs you to document all
of the symbols that you might use; i.e., there must be at least one
AC_DEFINE
or one AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED
call with a third
argument for each symbol (see section 7.1 Defining C Preprocessor Symbols). An additional
constraint is that the first argument of AC_DEFINE
must be a
literal. Note that all symbols defined by Autoconf's builtin tests are
already documented properly; you only need to document those that you
define yourself.
You might wonder why autoheader
is needed: after all, why
would configure
need to "patch" a `config.h.in' to
produce a `config.h' instead of just creating `config.h' from
scratch? Well, when everything rocks, the answer is just that we are
wasting our time maintaining autoheader
: generating
`config.h' directly is all that is needed. When things go wrong,
however, you'll be thankful for the existence of autoheader
.
The fact that the symbols are documented is important in order to
check that `config.h' makes sense. The fact that there is a
well-defined list of symbols that should be #define
'd (or not) is
also important for people who are porting packages to environments where
configure
cannot be run: they just have to fill in the
blanks.
But let's come back to the point: autoheader
's invocation...
If you give autoheader
an argument, it uses that file instead
of `configure.ac' and writes the header file to the standard output
instead of to `config.h.in'. If you give autoheader
an
argument of `-', it reads the standard input instead of
`configure.ac' and writes the header file to the standard output.
autoheader
accepts the following options:
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
autoheader
scans `configure.ac' and figures out which C
preprocessor symbols it might define. It knows how to generate
templates for symbols defined by AC_CHECK_HEADERS
,
AC_CHECK_FUNCS
etc., but if you AC_DEFINE
any additional
symbol, you must define a template for it. If there are missing
templates, autoheader
fails with an error message.
The simplest way to create a template for a symbol is to supply the description argument to an `AC_DEFINE(symbol)'; see 7.1 Defining C Preprocessor Symbols. You may also use one of the following macros.
autoheader
to include the template as-is in the header
template file. This template is associated with the key,
which is used to sort all the different templates and guarantee their
uniqueness. It should be a symbol that can be AC_DEFINE
'd.
For example:
AH_VERBATIM([_GNU_SOURCE], [/* Enable GNU extensions on systems that have them. */ #ifndef _GNU_SOURCE # define _GNU_SOURCE #endif]) |
autoheader
to generate a template for key. This macro
generates standard templates just like AC_DEFINE
when a
description is given.
For example:
AH_TEMPLATE([CRAY_STACKSEG_END], [Define to one of _getb67, GETB67, getb67 for Cray-2 and Cray-YMP systems. This function is required for alloca.c support on those systems.]) |
will generate the following template, with the description properly justified.
/* Define to one of _getb67, GETB67, getb67 for Cray-2 and Cray-YMP systems. This function is required for alloca.c support on those systems. */ #undef CRAY_STACKSEG_END |
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
You can execute arbitrary commands before, during, and after
`config.status' is run. The three following macros accumulate the
commands to run when they are called multiple times.
AC_CONFIG_COMMANDS
replaces the obsolete macro
AC_OUTPUT_COMMANDS
; see 15.4 Obsolete Macros, for details.
configure
. Associate the commands with tag. Since
typically the cmds create a file, tag should naturally be
the name of that file. This macro is one of the instantiating macros;
see 4.5 Performing Configuration Actions.
Here is an unrealistic example:
fubar=42 AC_CONFIG_COMMANDS([fubar], [echo this is extra $fubar, and so on.], [fubar=$fubar]) |
Here is a better one:
AC_CONFIG_COMMANDS([time-stamp], [date >time-stamp]) |
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
You may find it convenient to create links whose destinations depend upon
results of tests. One can use AC_CONFIG_COMMANDS
but the
creation of relative symbolic links can be delicate when the package is
built in a directory different from the source directory.
AC_OUTPUT
link each of the existing files source to
the corresponding link name dest. Makes a symbolic link if
possible, otherwise a hard link if possible, otherwise a copy. The
dest and source names should be relative to the top level
source or build directory. This macro is one of the instantiating
macros; see 4.5 Performing Configuration Actions.
For example, this call:
AC_CONFIG_LINKS(host.h:config/$machine.h object.h:config/$obj_format.h) |
creates in the current directory `host.h' as a link to `srcdir/config/$machine.h', and `object.h' as a link to `srcdir/config/$obj_format.h'.
The tempting value `.' for dest is invalid: it makes it impossible for `config.status' to guess the links to establish.
One can then run:
./config.status host.h object.h |
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
In most situations, calling AC_OUTPUT
is sufficient to produce
`Makefile's in subdirectories. However, configure
scripts
that control more than one independent package can use
AC_CONFIG_SUBDIRS
to run configure
scripts for other
packages in subdirectories.
AC_OUTPUT
run configure
in each subdirectory
dir in the given whitespace-separated list. Each dir should
be a literal, i.e., please do not use:
if test "$package_foo_enabled" = yes; then $my_subdirs="$my_subdirs foo" fi AC_CONFIG_SUBDIRS($my_subdirs) |
because this prevents `./configure --help=recursive' from
displaying the options of the package foo
. Rather, you should
write:
if test "$package_foo_enabled" = yes; then AC_CONFIG_SUBDIRS(foo) fi |
If a given dir is not found, an error is reported: if the subdirectory is optional, write:
if test -d $srcdir/foo; then AC_CONFIG_SUBDIRS(foo) fi |
If a given dir contains configure.gnu
, it is run instead
of configure
. This is for packages that might use a
non-Autoconf script Configure
, which can't be called through a
wrapper configure
since it would be the same file on
case-insensitive filesystems. Likewise, if a dir contains
`configure.in' but no configure
, the Cygnus
configure
script found by AC_CONFIG_AUX_DIR
is used.
The subdirectory configure
scripts are given the same command
line options that were given to this configure
script, with minor
changes if needed, which include:
$prefix
, including if it was
defaulted, and if the default values of the top level and of the subdirectory
`configure' differ.
This macro also sets the output variable subdirs
to the list of
directories `dir ...'. `Makefile' rules can use
this variable to determine which subdirectories to recurse into.
This macro may be called multiple times.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
By default, configure
sets the prefix for files it installs to
`/usr/local'. The user of configure
can select a different
prefix using the `--prefix' and `--exec-prefix' options.
There are two ways to change the default: when creating
configure
, and when running it.
Some software packages might want to install in a directory other than
`/usr/local' by default. To accomplish that, use the
AC_PREFIX_DEFAULT
macro.
It may be convenient for users to have configure
guess the
installation prefix from the location of a related program that they
have already installed. If you wish to do that, you can call
AC_PREFIX_PROGRAM
.
PATH
, the way the shell does. If program
is found, set the prefix to the parent of the directory containing
program, else default the prefix as described above
(`/usr/local' or AC_PREFIX_DEFAULT
). For example, if
program is gcc
and the PATH
contains
`/usr/local/gnu/bin/gcc', set the prefix to `/usr/local/gnu'.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
These macros test for particular system features that packages might need or want to use. If you need to test for a kind of feature that none of these macros check for, you can probably do it by calling primitive test macros with appropriate arguments (see section 6. Writing Tests).
These tests print messages telling the user which feature they're
checking for, and what they find. They cache their results for future
configure
runs (see section 7.3 Caching Results).
Some of these macros set output variables. See section 4.7 Substitutions in Makefiles, for how to get their values. The phrase "define name" is used below as a shorthand to mean "define C preprocessor symbol name to the value 1". See section 7.1 Defining C Preprocessor Symbols, for how to get those symbol definitions into your program.
5.1 Common Behavior Macros' standard schemes 5.2 Alternative Programs Selecting between alternative programs 5.3 Files Checking for the existence of files 5.4 Library Files Library archives that might be missing 5.5 Library Functions C library functions that might be missing 5.6 Header Files Header files that might be missing 5.7 Declarations Declarations that may be missing 5.8 Structures Structures or members that might be missing 5.9 Types Types that might be missing 5.10 Compilers and Preprocessors Checking for compiling programs 5.11 System Services Operating system services 5.12 UNIX Variants Special kludges for specific UNIX variants
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Much effort has been expended to make Autoconf easy to learn. The most obvious way to reach this goal is simply to enforce standard interfaces and behaviors, avoiding exceptions as much as possible. Because of history and inertia, unfortunately, there are still too many exceptions in Autoconf; nevertheless, this section describes some of the common rules.
5.1.1 Standard Symbols Symbols defined by the macros 5.1.2 Default Includes Includes used by the generic macros
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
All the generic macros that AC_DEFINE
a symbol as a result of
their test transform their arguments to a standard alphabet.
First, argument is converted to upper case and any asterisks
(`*') are each converted to `P'. Any remaining characters
that are not alphanumeric are converted to underscores.
For instance,
AC_CHECK_TYPES(struct $Expensive*) |
will define the symbol `HAVE_STRUCT__EXPENSIVEP' if the check succeeds.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Several tests depend upon a set of header files. Since these headers are not universally available, tests actually have to provide a set of protected includes, such as:
#if TIME_WITH_SYS_TIME # include <sys/time.h> # include <time.h> #else # if HAVE_SYS_TIME_H # include <sys/time.h> # else # include <time.h> # endif #endif |
Unless you know exactly what you are doing, you should avoid using unconditional includes, and check the existence of the headers you include beforehand (see section 5.6 Header Files).
Most generic macros provide the following default set of includes:
#include <stdio.h> #if HAVE_SYS_TYPES_H # include <sys/types.h> #endif #if HAVE_SYS_STAT_H # include <sys/stat.h> #endif #if STDC_HEADERS # include <stdlib.h> # include <stddef.h> #else # if HAVE_STDLIB_H # include <stdlib.h> # endif #endif #if HAVE_STRING_H # if !STDC_HEADERS && HAVE_MEMORY_H # include <memory.h> # endif # include <string.h> #endif #if HAVE_STRINGS_H # include <strings.h> #endif #if HAVE_INTTYPES_H # include <inttypes.h> #else # if HAVE_STDINT_H # include <stdint.h> # endif #endif #if HAVE_UNISTD_H # include <unistd.h> #endif |
If the default includes are used, then Autoconf will automatically check
for the presence of these headers and their compatibility, i.e., you
don't need to run AC_HEADERS_STDC
, nor check for `stdlib.h'
etc.
These headers are checked for in the same order as they are included.
For instance, on some systems `string.h' and `strings.h' both
exist, but conflict. Then HAVE_STRING_H
will be defined, but
HAVE_STRINGS_H
won't.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
These macros check for the presence or behavior of particular programs. They are used to choose between several alternative programs and to decide what to do once one has been chosen. If there is no macro specifically defined to check for a program you need, and you don't need to check for any special properties of it, then you can use one of the general program-check macros.
5.2.1 Particular Program Checks Special handling to find certain programs 5.2.2 Generic Program and File Checks How to find other programs
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
These macros check for particular programs--whether they exist, and in some cases whether they support certain features.
gawk
, mawk
, nawk
, and awk
, in that
order, and set output variable AWK
to the first one that is found.
It tries gawk
first because that is reported to be the
best implementation.
grep -E
and egrep
, in that order, and set
output variable EGREP
to the first one that is found.
grep -F
and fgrep
, in that order, and set
output variable FGREP
to the first one that is found.
INSTALL
to the path of a BSD-compatible
install
program, if one is found in the current PATH
.
Otherwise, set INSTALL
to `dir/install-sh -c',
checking the directories specified to AC_CONFIG_AUX_DIR
(or its
default directories) to determine dir (see section 4.4 Outputting Files). Also set
the variables INSTALL_PROGRAM
and INSTALL_SCRIPT
to
`${INSTALL}' and INSTALL_DATA
to `${INSTALL} -m 644'.
This macro screens out various instances of install
known not to
work. It prefers to find a C program rather than a shell script, for
speed. Instead of `install-sh', it can also use `install.sh',
but that name is obsolete because some make
programs have a rule
that creates `install' from it if there is no `Makefile'.
Autoconf comes with a copy of `install-sh' that you can use. If
you use AC_PROG_INSTALL
, you must include either
`install-sh' or `install.sh' in your distribution, or
configure
will produce an error message saying it can't find
them--even if the system you're on has a good install
program.
This check is a safety measure to prevent you from accidentally leaving
that file out, which would prevent your package from installing on
systems that don't have a BSD-compatible install
program.
If you need to use your own installation program because it has features
not found in standard install
programs, there is no reason to use
AC_PROG_INSTALL
; just put the file name of your program into your
`Makefile.in' files.
flex
is found, set output variable LEX
to `flex'
and LEXLIB
to `-lfl', if that library is in a standard
place. Otherwise set LEX
to `lex' and LEXLIB
to
`-ll'.
Define YYTEXT_POINTER
if yytext
is a `char *' instead
of a `char []'. Also set output variable LEX_OUTPUT_ROOT
to
the base of the file name that the lexer generates; usually
`lex.yy', but sometimes something else. These results vary
according to whether lex
or flex
is being used.
You are encouraged to use Flex in your sources, since it is both more
pleasant to use than plain Lex and the C source it produces is portable.
In order to ensure portability, however, you must either provide a
function yywrap
or, if you don't use it (e.g., your scanner has
no `#include'-like feature), simply include a `%noyywrap'
statement in the scanner's source. Once this done, the scanner is
portable (unless you felt free to use nonportable constructs) and
does not depend on any library. In this case, and in this case only, it
is suggested that you use this Autoconf snippet:
AC_PROG_LEX if test "$LEX" != flex; then LEX="$SHELL $missing_dir/missing flex" AC_SUBST(LEX_OUTPUT_ROOT, lex.yy) AC_SUBST(LEXLIB, '') fi |
The shell script missing
can be found in the Automake
distribution.
To ensure backward compatibility, Automake's AM_PROG_LEX
invokes
(indirectly) this macro twice, which will cause an annoying but benign
"AC_PROG_LEX
invoked multiple times" warning. Future versions
of Automake will fix this issue; meanwhile, just ignore this message.
LN_S
to `ln -s'; otherwise, if `ln' works, set
LN_S
to `ln', and otherwise set it to `cp -p'.
If you make a link in a directory other than the current directory, its
meaning depends on whether `ln' or `ln -s' is used. To safely
create links using `$(LN_S)', either find out which form is used
and adjust the arguments, or always invoke ln
in the directory
where the link is to be created.
In other words, it does not work to do:
$(LN_S) foo /x/bar |
Instead, do:
(cd /x && $(LN_S) foo bar) |
RANLIB
to `ranlib' if ranlib
is found, and otherwise to `:' (do nothing).
bison
is found, set output variable YACC
to `bison
-y'. Otherwise, if byacc
is found, set YACC
to
`byacc'. Otherwise set YACC
to `yacc'.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
These macros are used to find programs not covered by the "particular"
test macros. If you need to check the behavior of a program as well as
find out whether it is present, you have to write your own test for it
(see section 6. Writing Tests). By default, these macros use the environment
variable PATH
. If you need to check for a program that might not
be in the user's PATH
, you can pass a modified path to use
instead, like this:
AC_PATH_PROG([INETD], [inetd], [/usr/libexec/inetd], [$PATH:/usr/libexec:/usr/sbin:/usr/etc:etc]) |
You are strongly encouraged to declare the variable passed to
AC_CHECK_PROG
etc. as precious, See section 7.2 Setting Output Variables,
AC_ARG_VAR
, for more details.
PATH
. If
it is found, set variable to value-if-found, otherwise to
value-if-not-found, if given. Always pass over reject (an
absolute file name) even if it is the first found in the search path; in
that case, set variable using the absolute file name of the
prog-to-check-for found that is not reject. If
variable was already set, do nothing. Calls AC_SUBST
for
variable.
PATH
. If one is found, set
variable to the name of that program. Otherwise, continue
checking the next program in the list. If none of the programs in the
list are found, set variable to value-if-not-found; if
value-if-not-found is not specified, the value of variable
is not changed. Calls AC_SUBST
for variable.
AC_CHECK_PROG
, but first looks for prog-to-check-for
with a prefix of the host type as determined by
AC_CANONICAL_HOST
, followed by a dash (see section 11.2 Getting the Canonical System Type).
For example, if the user runs `configure --host=i386-gnu', then
this call:
AC_CHECK_TOOL(RANLIB, ranlib, :) |
RANLIB
to `i386-gnu-ranlib' if that program exists in
PATH
, or otherwise to `ranlib' if that program exists in
PATH
, or to `:' if neither program exists.
AC_CHECK_TOOL
, each of the tools in the list
progs-to-check-for are checked with a prefix of the host type as
determined by AC_CANONICAL_HOST
, followed by a dash
(see section 11.2 Getting the Canonical System Type). If none of the tools can be found with a
prefix, then the first one without a prefix is used. If a tool is found,
set variable to the name of that program. If none of the tools in
the list are found, set variable to value-if-not-found; if
value-if-not-found is not specified, the value of variable
is not changed. Calls AC_SUBST
for variable.
AC_CHECK_PROG
, but set variable to the entire
path of prog-to-check-for if found.
AC_CHECK_PROGS
, but if any of progs-to-check-for
are found, set variable to the entire path of the program
found.
AC_CHECK_TOOL
, but set variable to the entire
path of the program if it is found.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
You might also need to check for the existence of files. Before using these macros, ask yourself whether a run-time test might not be a better solution. Be aware that, like most Autoconf macros, they test a feature of the host machine, and therefore, they die when cross-compiling.
AC_CHECK_FILE
once for each file listed in files.
Additionally, defines `HAVE_file' (see section 5.1.1 Standard Symbols)
for each file found.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
The following macros check for the presence of certain C, C++, or Fortran 77 library archive files.
action-if-found is a list of shell commands to run if the link
with the library succeeds; action-if-not-found is a list of shell
commands to run if the link fails. If action-if-found is not
specified, the default action will prepend `-llibrary' to
LIBS
and define `HAVE_LIBlibrary' (in all
capitals). This macro is intended to support building LIBS
in
a right-to-left (least-dependent to most-dependent) fashion such that
library dependencies are satisfied as a natural side-effect of
consecutive tests. Some linkers are very sensitive to library ordering
so the order in which LIBS
is generated is important to reliable
detection of libraries.
If linking with library results in unresolved symbols that would
be resolved by linking with additional libraries, give those libraries
as the other-libraries argument, separated by spaces:
e.g., `-lXt -lX11'. Otherwise, this macro will fail to detect
that library is present, because linking the test program will
always fail with unresolved symbols. The other-libraries argument
should be limited to cases where it is desirable to test for one library
in the presence of another that is not already in LIBS
.
Add `-llibrary' to LIBS
for the first library found
to contain function, and run action-if-found. If the
function is not found, run action-if-not-found.
If linking with library results in unresolved symbols that would be resolved by linking with additional libraries, give those libraries as the other-libraries argument, separated by spaces: e.g., `-lXt -lX11'. Otherwise, this macro will fail to detect that function is present, because linking the test program will always fail with unresolved symbols.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
The following macros check for particular C library functions. If there is no macro specifically defined to check for a function you need, and you don't need to check for any special properties of it, then you can use one of the general function-check macros.
5.5.1 Portability of C Functions Pitfalls with usual functions 5.5.2 Particular Function Checks Special handling to find certain functions 5.5.3 Generic Function Checks How to find other functions
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Most usual functions can either be missing, or be buggy, or be limited on some architectures. This section tries to make an inventory of these portability issues. By definition, this list will always require additions. Please help us keeping it as complete as possible.
exit
exit
returns int
?
This is because exit
predates void
, and there was a long
tradition of it returning int
.
snprintf
snprintf
and vsnprintf
truncate the output and return the number of bytes that ought to have
been produced. Some older systems return the truncated length (e.g.,
GNU C Library 2.0.x or IRIX 6.5), some a negative value
(e.g., earlier GNU C Library versions), and some the buffer
length without truncation (e.g., 32-bit Solaris 7). Also, some buggy
older systems ignore the length and overrun the buffer (e.g., 64-bit
Solaris 7).
sprintf
sprintf
and vsprintf
return the
number of bytes written, but on some old systems (SunOS 4 for
instance) they return the buffer pointer instead.
sscanf
sscanf
requires that its
input string be writable (though it doesn't actually change it). This
can be a problem when using gcc
since it normally puts
constant strings in read-only memory
(see section `Incompatibilities' in Using and Porting the GNU Compiler Collection). Apparently in some cases even
having format strings read-only can be a problem.
strnlen
strnlen ("foobar", 0) = 0 strnlen ("foobar", 1) = 3 strnlen ("foobar", 2) = 2 strnlen ("foobar", 3) = 1 strnlen ("foobar", 4) = 0 strnlen ("foobar", 5) = 6 strnlen ("foobar", 6) = 6 strnlen ("foobar", 7) = 6 strnlen ("foobar", 8) = 6 strnlen ("foobar", 9) = 6 |
unlink
unlink
causes the given file to be
removed only after there are no more open file handles for it. Not all
OS's support this behavior though. So even on systems that provide
unlink
, you cannot portably assume it is OK to call it on files
that are open. For example, on Windows 9x and ME, such a call would fail;
on DOS it could even lead to file system corruption, as the file might end
up being written to after the OS has removed it.
va_copy
va_copy
for copying
va_list
variables. It may be available in older environments
too, though possibly as __va_copy
(e.g., gcc
in strict
C89 mode). These can be tested with #ifdef
. A fallback to
memcpy (&dst, &src, sizeof(va_list))
will give maximum
portability.
va_list
va_list
is not necessarily just a pointer. It can be a
struct
(e.g., gcc
on Alpha), which means NULL
is
not portable. Or it can be an array (e.g., gcc
in some
PowerPC configurations), which means as a function parameter it can be
effectively call-by-reference and library routines might modify the
value back in the caller (e.g., vsnprintf
in the GNU C Library
2.1).
>>
>>
right shift of a signed type replicates the
high bit, giving a so-called "arithmetic" shift. But care should be
taken since the ISO C standard doesn't require that behavior. On those
few processors without a native arithmetic shift (for instance Cray
vector systems) zero bits may be shifted in, the same as a shift of an
unsigned type.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
These macros check for particular C functions--whether they exist, and in some cases how they respond when given certain arguments.
alloca
. Tries to get a builtin version by
checking for `alloca.h' or the predefined C preprocessor macros
__GNUC__
and _AIX
. If this macro finds `alloca.h',
it defines HAVE_ALLOCA_H
.
If those attempts fail, it looks for the function in the standard C
library. If any of those methods succeed, it defines
HAVE_ALLOCA
. Otherwise, it sets the output variable
ALLOCA
to `alloca.o' and defines C_ALLOCA
(so
programs can periodically call `alloca(0)' to garbage collect).
This variable is separate from LIBOBJS
so multiple programs can
share the value of ALLOCA
without needing to create an actual
library, in case only some of them use the code in LIBOBJS
.
This macro does not try to get alloca
from the System V R3
`libPW' or the System V R4 `libucb' because those libraries
contain some incompatible functions that cause trouble. Some versions
do not even contain alloca
or contain a buggy version. If you
still want to use their alloca
, use ar
to extract
`alloca.o' from them instead of compiling `alloca.c'.
Source files that use alloca
should start with a piece of code
like the following, to declare it properly. In some versions of AIX,
the declaration of alloca
must precede everything else except for
comments and preprocessor directives. The #pragma
directive is
indented so that pre-ANSI C compilers will ignore it, rather than
choke on it.
/* AIX requires this to be the first thing in the file. */ #ifndef __GNUC__ # if HAVE_ALLOCA_H # include <alloca.h> # else # ifdef _AIX #pragma alloca # else # ifndef alloca /* predefined by HP cc +Olibcalls */ char *alloca (); # endif # endif # endif #endif |
chown
function is available and works (in particular, it
should accept `-1' for uid
and gid
), define
HAVE_CHOWN
.
closedir
function does not return a meaningful value,
define CLOSEDIR_VOID
. Otherwise, callers ought to check its
return value for an error indicator.
error_at_line
function is not found, require an
AC_LIBOBJ
replacement of `error'.
fnmatch
function conforms to POSIX, define
HAVE_FNMATCH
. Detect common implementation bugs, for example,
the bugs in Solaris 2.4.
Note that for historical reasons, contrary to the other specific
AC_FUNC
macros, AC_FUNC_FNMATCH
does not replace a
broken/missing fnmatch
. See AC_REPLACE_FNMATCH
below.
AC_REPLACE_FNMATCH
(replace) but also test
whether fnmatch
supports GNU extensions. Detect common
implementation bugs, for example, the bugs in the GNU C
Library 2.1.
fork
and vfork
functions. If a
working fork
is found, define HAVE_WORKING_FORK
. This macro
checks whether fork
is just a stub by trying to run it.
If `vfork.h' is found, define HAVE_VFORK_H
. If a working
vfork
is found, define HAVE_WORKING_VFORK
. Otherwise,
define vfork
to be fork
for backward compatibility with
previous versions of autoconf
. This macro checks for several known
errors in implementations of vfork
and considers the system to not
have a working vfork
if it detects any of them. It is not considered
to be an implementation error if a child's invocation of signal
modifies the parent's signal handler, since child processes rarely change
their signal handlers.
Since this macro defines vfork
only for backward compatibility with
previous versions of autoconf
you're encouraged to define it
yourself in new code:
#if !HAVE_WORKING_VFORK # define vfork fork #endif |
fseeko
function is available, define HAVE_FSEEKO
.
Define _LARGEFILE_SOURCE
if necessary.
getgroups
function is available and works (unlike on
Ultrix 4.3, where `getgroups (0, 0)' always fails), define
HAVE_GETGROUPS
. Set GETGROUPS_LIBS
to any libraries
needed to get that function. This macro runs AC_TYPE_GETGROUPS
.
AC_LIBOBJ
replacement directory properly (see
5.5.3 Generic Function Checks, AC_CONFIG_LIBOBJ_DIR
).
If the system has the getloadavg
function, define
HAVE_GETLOADAVG
, and set GETLOADAVG_LIBS
to any libraries
needed to get that function. Also add GETLOADAVG_LIBS
to
LIBS
. Otherwise, require an AC_LIBOBJ
replacement for
`getloadavg' with source code in `dir/getloadavg.c', and
possibly define several other C preprocessor macros and output
variables:
C_GETLOADAVG
.
SVR4
, DGUX
, UMAX
, or UMAX4_3
if on
those systems.
HAVE_NLIST_H
.
HAVE_STRUCT_NLIST_N_UN_N_NAME
. The obsolete symbol
NLIST_NAME_UNION
is still defined, but do not depend upon it.
getloadavg
to work. In this case, define
GETLOADAVG_PRIVILEGED
, set the output variable NEED_SETGID
to `true' (and otherwise to `false'), and set
KMEM_GROUP
to the name of the group that should own the installed
program.
getmntent
in the `sun', `seq', and `gen'
libraries, for IRIX 4, PTX, and Unixware, respectively. Then, if
getmntent
is available, define HAVE_GETMNTENT
.
GETPGRP_VOID
if it is an error to pass 0 to
getpgrp
; this is the POSIX behavior. On older BSD
systems, you must pass 0 to getpgrp
, as it takes an argument and
behaves like POSIX's getpgid
.
#if GETPGRP_VOID pid = getpgrp (); #else pid = getpgrp (0); #endif |
This macro does not check whether
getpgrp
exists at all; if you need to work in that situation,
first call AC_CHECK_FUNC
for getpgrp
.
lstat
should treat
`link/' the same as `link/.'. However, many older
lstat
implementations incorrectly ignore trailing slashes.
It is safe to assume that if lstat
incorrectly ignores
trailing slashes, then other symbolic-link-aware functions like
unlink
also incorrectly ignore trailing slashes.
If lstat
behaves properly, define
LSTAT_FOLLOWS_SLASHED_SYMLINK
, otherwise require an
AC_LIBOBJ
replacement of lstat
.
malloc
function is compatible with the GNU C
library malloc
(i.e., `malloc (0)' returns a valid
pointer), define HAVE_MALLOC
to 1. Otherwise define
HAVE_MALLOC
to 0, ask for an AC_LIBOBJ
replacement for
`malloc', and define malloc
to rpl_malloc
so that the
native malloc
is not used in the main project.
Typically, the replacement file `malloc.c' should look like (note the `#undef malloc'):
@verbatim #if HAVE_CONFIG_H # include <config.h> #endif #undef malloc
#include <sys/types.h>
void *malloc ();
/* Allocate an N-byte block of memory from the heap. If N is zero, allocate a 1-byte block. */
void * rpl_malloc (size_t n) { if (n == 0) n = 1; return malloc (n); }
memcmp
function is not available, or does not work on
8-bit data (like the one on SunOS 4.1.3), or fails when comparing 16
bytes or more and with at least one buffer not starting on a 4-byte
boundary (such as the one on NeXT x86 OpenStep), require an
AC_LIBOBJ
replacement for `memcmp'.
HAVE_MBRTOWC
to 1 if the function mbrtowc
and the
type mbstate_t
are properly declared.
mktime
function is not available, or does not work
correctly, require an AC_LIBOBJ
replacement for `mktime'.
mmap
function exists and works correctly, define
HAVE_MMAP
. Only checks private fixed mapping of already-mapped
memory.
HAVE_OBSTACK
, else require an
AC_LIBOBJ
replacement for `obstack'.
realloc
function is compatible with the GNU C
library realloc
(i.e., `realloc (0, 0)' returns a
valid pointer), define HAVE_REALLOC
to 1. Otherwise define
HAVE_REALLOC
to 0, ask for an AC_LIBOBJ
replacement for
`realloc', and define realloc
to rpl_realloc
so that
the native realloc
is not used in the main project. See
AC_FUNC_MALLOC
for details.
select
function's arguments, and defines those types
in SELECT_TYPE_ARG1
, SELECT_TYPE_ARG234
, and
SELECT_TYPE_ARG5
respectively. SELECT_TYPE_ARG1
defaults
to `int', SELECT_TYPE_ARG234
defaults to `int *',
and SELECT_TYPE_ARG5
defaults to `struct timeval *'.
setpgrp
takes no argument (the POSIX version), define
SETPGRP_VOID
. Otherwise, it is the BSD version, which takes
two process IDs as arguments. This macro does not check whether
setpgrp
exists at all; if you need to work in that situation,
first call AC_CHECK_FUNC
for setpgrp
.
stat
or lstat
have the bug that it
succeeds when given the zero-length file name as argument. The stat
and lstat
from SunOS 4.1.4 and the Hurd (as of 1998-11-01) do
this.
If it does, then define HAVE_STAT_EMPTY_STRING_BUG
(or
HAVE_LSTAT_EMPTY_STRING_BUG
) and ask for an AC_LIBOBJ
replacement of it.
setvbuf
takes the buffering type as its second argument and
the buffer pointer as the third, instead of the other way around, define
SETVBUF_REVERSED
.
strcoll
function exists and works correctly, define
HAVE_STRCOLL
. This does a bit more than
`AC_CHECK_FUNCS(strcoll)', because some systems have incorrect
definitions of strcoll
that should not be used.
strtod
function does not exist or doesn't work correctly,
ask for an AC_LIBOBJ
replacement of `strtod'. In this case,
because `strtod.c' is likely to need `pow', set the output
variable POW_LIB
to the extra library needed.
strerror_r
is available, define HAVE_STRERROR_R
, and if
it is declared, define HAVE_DECL_STRERROR_R
. If it returns a
char *
message, define STRERROR_R_CHAR_P
; otherwise it
returns an int
error number. The Thread-Safe Functions option of
POSIX requires strerror_r
to return int
, but
many systems (including, for example, version 2.2.4 of the GNU C
Library) return a char *
value that is not necessarily equal to
the buffer argument.
strftime
in the `intl' library, for SCO UNIX.
Then, if strftime
is available, define HAVE_STRFTIME
.
strnlen
function is not available, or is buggy (like the one
from AIX 4.3), require an AC_LIBOBJ
replacement for it.
HAVE_UTIME_NULL
.
vprintf
is found, define HAVE_VPRINTF
. Otherwise, if
_doprnt
is found, define HAVE_DOPRNT
. (If vprintf
is available, you may assume that vfprintf
and vsprintf
are also available.)
fnmatch
function does not conform to POSIX (see
AC_FUNC_FNMATCH
), ask for its AC_LIBOBJ
replacement.
The files `fnmatch.c', `fnmatch_loop.c', and `fnmatch_.h'
in the AC_LIBOBJ
replacement directory are assumed to contain a
copy of the source code of GNU fnmatch
. If necessary,
this source code is compiled as an AC_LIBOBJ
replacement, and the
`fnmatch_.h' file is linked to `fnmatch.h' so that it can be
included in place of the system <fnmatch.h>
.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
These macros are used to find functions not covered by the "particular"
test macros. If the functions might be in libraries other than the
default C library, first call AC_CHECK_LIB
for those libraries.
If you need to check the behavior of a function as well as find out
whether it is present, you have to write your own test for
it (see section 6. Writing Tests).
AC_CHECK_FUNCS
instead. This macro checks for functions with C
linkage even when AC_LANG(C++)
has been called, since C is more
standardized than C++. (see section 6.1 Language Choice, for more information
about selecting the language for checks.)
HAVE_function
(in all capitals) if it is available.
If action-if-found is given, it is additional shell code to
execute when one of the functions is found. You can give it a value of
`break' to break out of the loop on the first match. If
action-if-not-found is given, it is executed when one of the
functions is not found.
Autoconf follows a philosophy that was formed over the years by those who have struggled for portability: isolate the portability issues in specific files, and then program as if you were in a POSIX environment. Some functions may be missing or unfixable, and your package must be ready to replace them.
Technically, it adds `function.$ac_objext' to the output
variable LIBOBJS
and calls AC_LIBSOURCE
for
`function.c'. You should not directly change LIBOBJS
,
since this is not traceable.
AC_LIBSOURCE
. file must be a literal.
This macro is called automatically from AC_LIBOBJ
, but you must
call it explicitly if you pass a shell variable to AC_LIBOBJ
. In
that case, since shell variables cannot be traced statically, you must
pass to AC_LIBSOURCE
any possible files that the shell variable
might cause AC_LIBOBJ
to need. For example, if you want to pass
a variable $foo_or_bar
to AC_LIBOBJ
that holds either
"foo"
or "bar"
, you should do:
AC_LIBSOURCE(foo.c) AC_LIBSOURCE(bar.c) AC_LIBOBJ($foo_or_bar) |
There is usually a way to avoid this, however, and you are encouraged to
simply call AC_LIBOBJ
with literal arguments.
Note that this macro replaces the obsolete AC_LIBOBJ_DECL
, with
slightly different semantics: the old macro took the function name,
e.g., foo
, as its argument rather than the file name.
AC_LIBSOURCE
, but accepts one or more files in a
comma-separated M4 list. Thus, the above example might be rewritten:
AC_LIBSOURCES([foo.c, bar.c]) AC_LIBOBJ($foo_or_bar) |
AC_LIBOBJ
replacement files are to be found in
directory, a relative path starting from the top level of the
source tree. The replacement directory defaults to `.', the top
level directory, and the most typical value is `lib', corresponding
to `AC_CONFIG_LIBOBJ_DIR(lib)'.
configure
might need to know the replacement directory for the
following reasons: (i) some checks use the replacement files, (ii) some
macros bypass broken system headers by installing links to the
replacement headers, etc.
It is common to merely check for the existence of a function, and ask
for its AC_LIBOBJ
replacement if missing. The following macro is
a convenient shorthand.
AC_CHECK_FUNCS
, but uses `AC_LIBOBJ(function)' as
action-if-not-found. You can declare your replacement function by
enclosing the prototype in `#if !HAVE_function'. If the
system has the function, it probably declares it in a header file you
should be including, so you shouldn't redeclare it lest your declaration
conflict.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
The following macros check for the presence of certain C header files. If there is no macro specifically defined to check for a header file you need, and you don't need to check for any special properties of it, then you can use one of the general header-file check macros.
5.6.1 Portability of Headers Collected knowledge on common headers 5.6.2 Particular Header Checks Special handling to find certain headers 5.6.3 Generic Header Checks How to find other headers
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
This section tries to collect knowledge about common headers, and the problems they cause. By definition, this list will always require additions. Please help us keeping it as complete as possible.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
These macros check for particular system header files--whether they exist, and in some cases whether they declare certain symbols.
`dirent.h' | HAVE_DIRENT_H |
`sys/ndir.h' | HAVE_SYS_NDIR_H |
`sys/dir.h' | HAVE_SYS_DIR_H |
`ndir.h' | HAVE_NDIR_H |
The directory-library declarations in your source code should look something like the following:
#if HAVE_DIRENT_H # include <dirent.h> # define NAMLEN(dirent) strlen((dirent)->d_name) #else # define dirent direct # define NAMLEN(dirent) (dirent)->d_namlen # if HAVE_SYS_NDIR_H # include <sys/ndir.h> # endif # if HAVE_SYS_DIR_H # include <sys/dir.h> # endif # if HAVE_NDIR_H # include <ndir.h> # endif #endif |
Using the above declarations, the program would declare variables to be
of type struct dirent
, not struct direct
, and would access
the length of a directory entry name by passing a pointer to a
struct dirent
to the NAMLEN
macro.
This macro also checks for the SCO Xenix `dir' and `x' libraries.
major
, minor
, and
makedev
, but `sys/mkdev.h' does, define
MAJOR_IN_MKDEV
; otherwise, if `sys/sysmacros.h' does, define
MAJOR_IN_SYSMACROS
.
S_ISDIR
, S_ISREG
, etc. defined in
`sys/stat.h' do not work properly (returning false positives),
define STAT_MACROS_BROKEN
. This is the case on Tektronix UTekV,
Amdahl UTS and Motorola System V/88.
HAVE_STDBOOL_H
to 1; if the type _Bool
is defined, define
HAVE__BOOL
to 1. To fulfill the C99 requirements, your
`system.h' should contain the following code:
@verbatim #if HAVE_STDBOOL_H # include <stdbool.h> #else # if ! HAVE__BOOL # ifdef __cplusplus typedef bool _Bool; # else typedef unsigned char _Bool; # endif # endif # define bool _Bool # define false 0 # define true 1 # define __bool_true_false_are_defined 1 #endif
STDC_HEADERS
if the system has ANSI C header files.
Specifically, this macro checks for `stdlib.h', `stdarg.h',
`string.h', and `float.h'; if the system has those, it
probably has the rest of the ANSI C header files. This macro also
checks whether `string.h' declares memchr
(and thus
presumably the other mem
functions), whether `stdlib.h'
declare free
(and thus presumably malloc
and other related
functions), and whether the `ctype.h' macros work on characters
with the high bit set, as ANSI C requires.
Use STDC_HEADERS
instead of __STDC__
to determine whether
the system has ANSI-compliant header files (and probably C library
functions) because many systems that have GCC do not have ANSI C
header files.
On systems without ANSI C headers, there is so much variation that it is probably easier to declare the functions you use than to figure out exactly what the system header files declare. Some systems contain a mix of functions from ANSI and BSD; some are mostly ANSI but lack `memmove'; some define the BSD functions as macros in `string.h' or `strings.h'; some have only the BSD functions but `string.h'; some declare the memory functions in `memory.h', some in `string.h'; etc. It is probably sufficient to check for one string function and one memory function; if the library has the ANSI versions of those then it probably has most of the others. If you put the following in `configure.ac':
AC_HEADER_STDC AC_CHECK_FUNCS(strchr memcpy) |
then, in your code, you can use declarations like this:
#if STDC_HEADERS # include <string.h> #else # if !HAVE_STRCHR # define strchr index # define strrchr rindex # endif char *strchr (), *strrchr (); # if !HAVE_MEMCPY # define memcpy(d, s, n) bcopy ((s), (d), (n)) # define memmove(d, s, n) bcopy ((s), (d), (n)) # endif #endif |
If you use a function like memchr
, memset
, strtok
,
or strspn
, which have no BSD equivalent, then macros won't
suffice; you must provide an implementation of each function. An easy
way to incorporate your implementations only when needed (since the ones
in system C libraries may be hand optimized) is to, taking memchr
for example, put it in `memchr.c' and use
`AC_REPLACE_FUNCS(memchr)'.
HAVE_SYS_WAIT_H
. Incompatibility can occur if `sys/wait.h'
does not exist, or if it uses the old BSD union wait
instead
of int
to store a status value. If `sys/wait.h' is not
POSIX compatible, then instead of including it, define the
POSIX macros with their usual interpretations. Here is an
example:
#include <sys/types.h> #if HAVE_SYS_WAIT_H # include <sys/wait.h> #endif #ifndef WEXITSTATUS # define WEXITSTATUS(stat_val) ((unsigned)(stat_val) >> 8) #endif #ifndef WIFEXITED # define WIFEXITED(stat_val) (((stat_val) & 255) == 0) #endif |
_POSIX_VERSION
is defined when `unistd.h' is included on
POSIX systems. If there is no `unistd.h', it is definitely
not a POSIX system. However, some non-POSIX systems do
have `unistd.h'.
The way to check if the system supports POSIX is:
#if HAVE_UNISTD_H # include <sys/types.h> # include <unistd.h> #endif #ifdef _POSIX_VERSION /* Code for POSIX systems. */ #endif |
TIME_WITH_SYS_TIME
. On some older systems,
`sys/time.h' includes `time.h', but `time.h' is not
protected against multiple inclusion, so programs should not explicitly
include both files. This macro is useful in programs that use, for
example, struct timeval
as well as
struct tm
. It is best used in conjunction with
HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
, which can be checked for using
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(sys/time.h)
.
#if TIME_WITH_SYS_TIME # include <sys/time.h> # include <time.h> #else # if HAVE_SYS_TIME_H # include <sys/time.h> # else # include <time.h> # endif #endif |
TIOCGWINSZ
requires `<sys/ioctl.h>', then
define GWINSZ_IN_SYS_IOCTL
. Otherwise TIOCGWINSZ
can be
found in `<termios.h>'.
Use:
#if HAVE_TERMIOS_H # include <termios.h> #endif #if GWINSZ_IN_SYS_IOCTL # include <sys/ioctl.h> #endif |
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
These macros are used to find system header files not covered by the "particular" test macros. If you need to check the contents of a header as well as find out whether it is present, you have to write your own test for it (see section 6. Writing Tests).
AC_CHECK_HEADERS
instead.
For compatibility issues with older versions of Autoconf, please read below.
HAVE_header-file
(in all capitals). If action-if-found
is given, it is additional shell code to execute when one of the header
files is found. You can give it a value of `break' to break out of
the loop on the first match. If action-if-not-found is given, it
is executed when one of the header files is not found.
For compatibility issues with older versions of Autoconf, please read below.
Previous versions of Autoconf merely checked whether the header was
accepted by the preprocessor. This was changed because the old test was
inappropriate for typical uses. Headers are typically used to compile,
not merely to preprocess, and the old behavior sometimes accepted
headers that clashed at compile-time. If you need to check whether a
header is preprocessable, you can use AC_PREPROC_IFELSE
(see section 6.3 Running the Preprocessor).
This scheme, which improves the robustness of the test, also requires that you make sure that headers that must be included before the header-file be part of the includes, (see section 5.1.2 Default Includes). If looking for `bar.h', which requires that `foo.h' be included before if it exists, we suggest the following scheme:
@verbatim AC_CHECK_HEADERS([foo.h]) AC_CHECK_HEADERS([bar.h], [], [], [#if HAVE_FOO_H # include <foo.h> # endif ])
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
The following macros check for the declaration of variables and
functions. If there is no macro specifically defined to check for a
symbol you need, then you can use the general macros (see section 5.7.2 Generic Declaration Checks) or, for more complex tests, you may use
AC_COMPILE_IFELSE
(see section 6.4 Running the Compiler).
5.7.1 Particular Declaration Checks Macros to check for certain declarations 5.7.2 Generic Declaration Checks How to find other declarations
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
There are no specific macros for declarations.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
These macros are used to find declarations not covered by the "particular" test macros.
This macro actually tests whether it is valid to use symbol as an r-value, not if it is really declared, because it is much safer to avoid introducing extra declarations when they are not needed.
HAVE_DECL_symbol
(in all capitals) to `1' if
symbol is declared, otherwise to `0'. If
action-if-not-found is given, it is additional shell code to
execute when one of the function declarations is needed, otherwise
action-if-found is executed.
This macro uses an m4 list as first argument:
AC_CHECK_DECLS(strdup) AC_CHECK_DECLS([strlen]) AC_CHECK_DECLS([malloc, realloc, calloc, free]) |
Unlike the other `AC_CHECK_*S' macros, when a symbol is not
declared, HAVE_DECL_symbol
is defined to `0' instead
of leaving HAVE_DECL_symbol
undeclared. When you are
sure that the check was performed, use
HAVE_DECL_symbol
just like any other result of Autoconf:
#if !HAVE_DECL_SYMBOL extern char *symbol; #endif |
If the test may have not been performed, however, because it is safer not to declare a symbol than to use a declaration that conflicts with the system's one, you should use:
#if defined HAVE_DECL_MALLOC && !HAVE_DECL_MALLOC void *malloc (size_t *s); #endif |
You fall into the second category only in extreme situations: either your files may be used without being configured, or they are used during the configuration. In most cases the traditional approach is enough.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
The following macros check for the presence of certain members in C
structures. If there is no macro specifically defined to check for a
member you need, then you can use the general structure-member macros
(see section 5.8.2 Generic Structure Checks) or, for more complex tests, you may use
AC_COMPILE_IFELSE
(see section 6.4 Running the Compiler).
5.8.1 Particular Structure Checks Macros to check for certain structure members 5.8.2 Generic Structure Checks How to find other structure members
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
The following macros check for certain structures or structure members.
struct stat
contains an st_blksize
member, define
HAVE_STRUCT_STAT_ST_BLKSIZE
. The former name,
HAVE_ST_BLKSIZE
is to be avoided, as its support will cease in
the future. This macro is obsoleted, and should be replaced by
AC_CHECK_MEMBERS([struct stat.st_blksize]) |
struct stat
contains an st_blocks
member, define
HAVE_STRUCT STAT_ST_BLOCKS
. Otherwise, require an
AC_LIBOBJ
replacement of `fileblocks'. The former name,
HAVE_ST_BLOCKS
is to be avoided, as its support will cease in the
future.
struct stat
contains an st_rdev
member, define
HAVE_STRUCT_STAT_ST_RDEV
. The former name for this macro,
HAVE_ST_RDEV
, is to be avoided as it will cease to be supported
in the future. Actually, even the new macro is obsolete and should be
replaced by:
AC_CHECK_MEMBERS([struct stat.st_rdev]) |
struct tm
, define
TM_IN_SYS_TIME
, which means that including `sys/time.h'
had better define struct tm
.
struct tm
has a
tm_zone
member, define HAVE_STRUCT_TM_TM_ZONE
(and the
obsoleted HAVE_TM_ZONE
). Otherwise, if the external array
tzname
is found, define HAVE_TZNAME
.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
These macros are used to find structure members not covered by the "particular" test macros.
AC_CHECK_MEMBER(struct passwd.pw_gecos,, [AC_MSG_ERROR([We need `passwd.pw_gecos'!])], [#include <pwd.h>]) |
You can use this macro for sub-members:
AC_CHECK_MEMBER(struct top.middle.bot) |
HAVE_aggregate_member
(in all
capitals, with spaces and dots replaced by underscores).
This macro uses m4 lists:
AC_CHECK_MEMBERS([struct stat.st_rdev, struct stat.st_blksize]) |
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
The following macros check for C types, either builtin or typedefs. If there is no macro specifically defined to check for a type you need, and you don't need to check for any special properties of it, then you can use a general type-check macro.
5.9.1 Particular Type Checks Special handling to find certain types 5.9.2 Generic Type Checks How to find other types
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
These macros check for particular C types in `sys/types.h', `stdlib.h' and others, if they exist.
GETGROUPS_T
to be whichever of gid_t
or int
is the base type of the array argument to getgroups
.
HAVE_MBSTATE_T
if <wchar.h>
declares the
mbstate_t
type. Also, define mbstate_t
to be a type if
<wchar.h>
does not declare it.
signal
as returning a pointer to a
function returning void
, define RETSIGTYPE
to be
void
; otherwise, define it to be int
.
Define signal handlers as returning type RETSIGTYPE
:
RETSIGTYPE hup_handler () { ... } |
uid_t
is not defined, define uid_t
to be int
and
gid_t
to be int
.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
These macros are used to check for types not covered by the "particular" test macros.
HAVE_type
(in all capitals). If no includes are
specified, the default includes are used (see section 5.1.2 Default Includes). If
action-if-found is given, it is additional shell code to execute
when one of the types is found. If action-if-not-found is given,
it is executed when one of the types is not found.
This macro uses m4 lists:
AC_CHECK_TYPES(ptrdiff_t) AC_CHECK_TYPES([unsigned long long, uintmax_t]) |
Autoconf, up to 2.13, used to provide to another version of
AC_CHECK_TYPE
, broken by design. In order to keep backward
compatibility, a simple heuristics, quite safe but not totally, is
implemented. In case of doubt, read the documentation of the former
AC_CHECK_TYPE
, see 15.4 Obsolete Macros.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
All the tests for compilers (AC_PROG_CC
, AC_PROG_CXX
,
AC_PROG_F77
) define the output variable EXEEXT
based on
the output of the compiler, typically to the empty string if Unix and
`.exe' if Win32 or OS/2.
They also define the output variable OBJEXT
based on the
output of the compiler, after `.c' files have been excluded, typically
to `o' if Unix, `obj' if Win32.
If the compiler being used does not produce executables, the tests fail. If the executables can't be run, and cross-compilation is not enabled, they fail too. See section 11. Manual Configuration, for more on support for cross compiling.
5.10.1 Specific Compiler Characteristics Some portability issues 5.10.2 Generic Compiler Characteristics Language independent tests 5.10.3 C Compiler Characteristics Checking its characteristics 5.10.4 C++ Compiler Characteristics Likewise 5.10.5 Fortran 77 Compiler Characteristics Likewise
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Some compilers exhibit different behaviors.
int main (void) { static int test_array [sizeof (int) == 4 ? 1 : -1]; test_array [0] = 0 return 0; } |
To our knowledge, there is a single compiler that does not support this trick: the HP C compilers (the real one, not only the "bundled") on HP-UX 11.00:
$ cc -c -Ae +O2 +Onolimit conftest.c cc: "conftest.c": error 1879: Variable-length arrays cannot \ have static storage. |
Autoconf works around this problem by casting sizeof (int)
to
long
before comparing it.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
SIZEOF_type
(see section 5.1.1 Standard Symbols) to be the
size in bytes of type. If `type' is unknown, it gets a size
of 0. If no includes are specified, the default includes are used
(see section 5.1.2 Default Includes). If you provide include, be sure to
include `stdio.h' which is required for this macro to run.
This macro now works even when cross-compiling. The unused argument was used when cross-compiling.
For example, the call
AC_CHECK_SIZEOF(int *) |
defines SIZEOF_INT_P
to be 8 on DEC Alpha AXP systems.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
The following macros provide ways to find and exercise a C Compiler. There are a few constructs that ought to be avoided, but do not deserve being checked for, since they can easily be worked around.
#ifdef __STDC__ /\ * A comment with backslash-newlines in it. %{ %} *\ \ / char str[] = "\\ " A string with backslash-newlines in it %{ %} \\ ""; char apostrophe = '\\ \ '\ '; #endif |
yields
error-->cpp: "foo.c", line 13: error 4048: Non-terminating comment at end of file. error-->cpp: "foo.c", line 13: error 4033: Missing #endif at end of file. |
Removing the lines with solitary backslashes solves the problem.
$ cc a.c b.c a.c: b.c: |
This can cause problems if you observe the output of the compiler to detect failures. Invoking `cc -c a.c -o a.o; cc -c b.c -o b.o; cc a.o b.o -o c' solves the issue.
CC
is not already set in the
environment, check for gcc
and cc
, then for other C
compilers. Set output variable CC
to the name of the compiler
found.
This macro may, however, be invoked with an optional first argument
which, if specified, must be a space separated list of C compilers to
search for. This just gives the user an opportunity to specify an
alternative search list for the C compiler. For example, if you didn't
like the default order, then you could invoke AC_PROG_CC
like
this:
AC_PROG_CC(cl egcs gcc cc) |
If the C compiler is not in ANSI C mode by default, try to add an
option to output variable CC
to make it so. This macro tries
various options that select ANSI C on some system or another. It
considers the compiler to be in ANSI C mode if it handles function
prototypes correctly.
After calling this macro you can check whether the C compiler has been
set to accept ANSI C; if not, the shell variable
ac_cv_prog_cc_stdc
is set to `no'. If you wrote your source
code in ANSI C, you can make an un-ANSIfied copy of it by
using the program ansi2knr
, which comes with Automake. See also
under AC_C_PROTOTYPES
below.
If using the GNU C compiler, set shell variable GCC
to
`yes'. If output variable CFLAGS
was not already set, set
it to `-g -O2' for the GNU C compiler (`-O2' on systems
where GCC does not accept `-g'), or `-g' for other compilers.
NO_MINUS_C_MINUS_O
. This macro actually
tests both the compiler found by AC_PROG_CC
, and, if different,
the first cc
in the path. The test fails if one fails. This
macro was created for GNU Make to choose the default C compilation
rule.
CPP
to a command that runs the
C preprocessor. If `$CC -E' doesn't work, `/lib/cpp' is used.
It is only portable to run CPP
on files with a `.c'
extension.
Some preprocessors don't indicate missing include files by the error status. For such preprocessors an internal variable is set that causes other macros to check the standard error from the preprocessor and consider the test failed if any warnings have been reported.
The following macros check for C compiler or machine architecture
features. To check for characteristics not listed here, use
AC_COMPILE_IFELSE
(see section 6.4 Running the Compiler) or
AC_RUN_IFELSE
(see section 6.6 Checking Run Time Behavior).
This macro runs a test-case if endianness cannot be determined from the system header files. When cross-compiling, the test-case is not run but grep'ed for some magic values. action-if-unknown is executed if the latter case fails to determine the byte sex of the host system.
The default for action-if-true is to define `WORDS_BIGENDIAN'. The default for action-if-false is to do nothing. And finally, the default for action-if-unknown is to abort configure and tell the installer which variable he should preset to bypass this test.
const
, define const
to be empty. Some C compilers that do
not define __STDC__
do support const
; some compilers that
define __STDC__
do not completely support const
. Programs
can simply use const
as if every C compiler supported it; for
those that don't, the `Makefile' or configuration header file will
define it as empty.
Occasionally installers use a C++ compiler to compile C code, typically
because they lack a C compiler. This causes problems with const
,
because C and C++ treat const
differently. For example:
const int foo; |
is valid in C but not in C++. These differences unfortunately cannot be
papered over by defining const
to be empty.
If autoconf
detects this situation, it leaves const
alone,
as this generally yields better results in practice. However, using a
C++ compiler to compile C code is not recommended or supported, and
installers who run into trouble in this area should get a C compiler
like GCC to compile their C code.
volatile
,
define volatile
to be empty. Programs can simply use
volatile
as if every C compiler supported it; for those that do
not, the `Makefile' or configuration header will define it as
empty.
If the correctness of your program depends on the semantics of
volatile
, simply defining it to be empty does, in a sense, break
your code. However, given that the compiler does not support
volatile
, you are at its mercy anyway. At least your
program will compile, when it wouldn't before.
In general, the volatile
keyword is a feature of ANSI C, so
you might expect that volatile
is available only when
__STDC__
is defined. However, Ultrix 4.3's native compiler does
support volatile, but does not defined __STDC__
.
inline
, do nothing.
Otherwise define inline
to __inline__
or __inline
if it accepts one of those, otherwise define inline
to be empty.
char
is unsigned, define __CHAR_UNSIGNED__
,
unless the C compiler predefines it.
long double
type with more
range or precision than the double
type, define
HAVE_LONG_DOUBLE
.
HAVE_STRINGIZE
. The stringizing operator is `#' and is
found in macros such as this:
#define x(y) #y |
AC_PROG_CC
), define PROTOTYPES
and __PROTOTYPES
.
In the case the compiler does not handle
prototypes, you should use ansi2knr
, which comes with the
Automake distribution, to unprotoize function definitions. For
function prototypes, you should first define PARAMS
:
#ifndef PARAMS # if PROTOTYPES # define PARAMS(protos) protos # else /* no PROTOTYPES */ # define PARAMS(protos) () # endif /* no PROTOTYPES */ #endif |
then use it this way:
size_t my_strlen PARAMS ((const char *)); |
This macro also defines __PROTOTYPES
; this is for the benefit of
header files that cannot use macros that infringe on user name space.
CC
if using the
GNU C compiler and ioctl
does not work properly without
`-traditional'. That usually happens when the fixed header files
have not been installed on an old system. Since recent versions of the
GNU C compiler fix the header files automatically when installed,
this is becoming a less prevalent problem.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
CXX
or CCC
(in that order) is set; if so, then set output
variable CXX
to its value.
Otherwise, if the macro is invoked without an argument, then search for
a C++ compiler under the likely names (first g++
and c++
then other names). If none of those checks succeed, then as a last
resort set CXX
to g++
.
This macro may, however, be invoked with an optional first argument
which, if specified, must be a space separated list of C++ compilers to
search for. This just gives the user an opportunity to specify an
alternative search list for the C++ compiler. For example, if you
didn't like the default order, then you could invoke AC_PROG_CXX
like this:
AC_PROG_CXX(cl KCC CC cxx cc++ xlC aCC c++ g++ egcs gcc) |
If using the GNU C++ compiler, set shell variable GXX
to
`yes'. If output variable CXXFLAGS
was not already set, set
it to `-g -O2' for the GNU C++ compiler (`-O2' on
systems where G++ does not accept `-g'), or `-g' for other
compilers.
CXXCPP
to a command that runs the C++
preprocessor. If `$CXX -E' doesn't work, `/lib/cpp' is used.
It is only portable to run CXXCPP
on files with a `.c',
`.C', or `.cc' extension.
Some preprocessors don't indicate missing include files by the error status. For such preprocessors an internal variable is set that causes other macros to check the standard error from the preprocessor and consider the test failed if any warnings have been reported. However, it is not known whether such broken preprocessors exist for C++.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
F77
is not already
set in the environment, then check for g77
and f77
, and
then some other names. Set the output variable F77
to the name
of the compiler found.
This macro may, however, be invoked with an optional first argument
which, if specified, must be a space separated list of Fortran 77
compilers to search for. This just gives the user an opportunity to
specify an alternative search list for the Fortran 77 compiler. For
example, if you didn't like the default order, then you could invoke
AC_PROG_F77
like this:
AC_PROG_F77(fl32 f77 fort77 xlf g77 f90 xlf90) |
If using g77
(the GNU Fortran 77 compiler), then
AC_PROG_F77
will set the shell variable G77
to `yes'.
If the output variable FFLAGS
was not already set in the
environment, then set it to `-g -02' for g77
(or `-O2'
where g77
does not accept `-g'). Otherwise, set
FFLAGS
to `-g' for all other Fortran 77 compilers.
F77_NO_MINUS_C_MINUS_O
if it
does not.
The following macros check for Fortran 77 compiler characteristics. To
check for characteristics not listed here, use AC_COMPILE_IFELSE
(see section 6.4 Running the Compiler) or AC_RUN_IFELSE
(see section 6.6 Checking Run Time Behavior), making sure to first set the current language to Fortran 77
AC_LANG(Fortran 77)
(see section 6.1 Language Choice).
FLIBS
is set to these flags.
This macro is intended to be used in those situations when it is necessary to mix, e.g., C++ and Fortran 77 source code into a single program or shared library (see section `Mixing Fortran 77 With C and C++' in GNU Automake).
For example, if object files from a C++ and Fortran 77 compiler must be linked together, then the C++ compiler/linker must be used for linking (since special C++-ish things need to happen at link time like calling global constructors, instantiating templates, enabling exception support, etc.).
However, the Fortran 77 intrinsic and run-time libraries must be linked
in as well, but the C++ compiler/linker doesn't know by default how to
add these Fortran 77 libraries. Hence, the macro
AC_F77_LIBRARY_LDFLAGS
was created to determine these Fortran 77
libraries.
The macro AC_F77_DUMMY_MAIN
or AC_F77_MAIN
will probably
also be necessary to link C/C++ with Fortran; see below.
AC_F77_LIBRARY_LDFLAGS
provide their own main
entry
function that initializes things like Fortran I/O, and which then calls
a user-provided entry function named (say) MAIN__
to run the
user's program. The AC_F77_DUMMY_MAIN
or AC_F77_MAIN
macro figures out how to deal with this interaction.
When using Fortran for purely numerical functions (no I/O, etc.) often one
prefers to provide one's own main
and skip the Fortran library
initializations. In this case, however, one may still need to provide a
dummy MAIN__
routine in order to prevent linking errors on some
systems. AC_F77_DUMMY_MAIN
detects whether any such routine is
required for linking, and what its name is; the shell variable
F77_DUMMY_MAIN
holds this name, unknown
when no solution
was found, and none
when no such dummy main is needed.
By default, action-if-found defines F77_DUMMY_MAIN
to the
name of this routine (e.g., MAIN__
) if it is required.
[action-if-not-found] defaults to exiting with an error.
In order to link with Fortran routines, the user's C/C++ program should then include the following code to define the dummy main if it is needed:
#ifdef F77_DUMMY_MAIN # ifdef __cplusplus extern "C" # endif int F77_DUMMY_MAIN() { return 1; } #endif |
Note that AC_F77_DUMMY_MAIN
is called automatically from
AC_F77_WRAPPERS
; there is generally no need to call it explicitly
unless one wants to change the default actions.
AC_F77_DUMMY_MAIN
, many Fortran libraries
allow you to provide an entry point called (say) MAIN__
instead of
the usual main
, which is then called by a main
function in
the Fortran libraries that initializes things like Fortran I/O. The
AC_F77_MAIN
macro detects whether it is possible to
utilize such an alternate main function, and defines F77_MAIN
to
the name of the function. (If no alternate main function name is found,
F77_MAIN
is simply defined to main
.)
Thus, when calling Fortran routines from C that perform things like I/O,
one should use this macro and name the "main" function F77_MAIN
instead of main
.
F77_FUNC(name,NAME)
and
F77_FUNC_(name,NAME)
to properly mangle the names of C/C++
identifiers, and identifiers with underscores, respectively, so that
they match the name-mangling scheme used by the Fortran 77 compiler.
Fortran 77 is case-insensitive, and in order to achieve this the Fortran
77 compiler converts all identifiers into a canonical case and format.
To call a Fortran 77 subroutine from C or to write a C function that is
callable from Fortran 77, the C program must explicitly use identifiers
in the format expected by the Fortran 77 compiler. In order to do this,
one simply wraps all C identifiers in one of the macros provided by
AC_F77_WRAPPERS
. For example, suppose you have the following
Fortran 77 subroutine:
subroutine foobar(x,y) double precision x, y y = 3.14159 * x return end |
You would then declare its prototype in C or C++ as:
#define FOOBAR_F77 F77_FUNC(foobar,FOOBAR) #ifdef __cplusplus extern "C" /* prevent C++ name mangling */ #endif void FOOBAR_F77(double *x, double *y); |
Note that we pass both the lowercase and uppercase versions of the
function name to F77_FUNC
so that it can select the right one.
Note also that all parameters to Fortran 77 routines are passed as
pointers (see section `Mixing Fortran 77 With C and C++' in GNU Automake).
Although Autoconf tries to be intelligent about detecting the
name-mangling scheme of the Fortran 77 compiler, there may be Fortran 77
compilers that it doesn't support yet. In this case, the above code
will generate a compile-time error, but some other behavior
(e.g., disabling Fortran-related features) can be induced by checking
whether the F77_FUNC
macro is defined.
Now, to call that routine from a C program, we would do something like:
{ double x = 2.7183, y; FOOBAR_F77(&x, &y); } |
If the Fortran 77 identifier contains an underscore
(e.g., foo_bar
), you should use F77_FUNC_
instead of
F77_FUNC
(with the same arguments). This is because some Fortran
77 compilers mangle names differently if they contain an underscore.
AC_F77_WRAPPERS
). shellvar is
optional; if it is not supplied, the shell variable will be simply
name. The purpose of this macro is to give the caller a way to
access the name-mangling information other than through the C
preprocessor as above, for example, to call Fortran routines from some
language other than C/C++.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
The following macros check for operating system services or capabilities.
xmkmf
on a
trivial `Imakefile' and examining the `Makefile' that it
produces. If that fails (such as if xmkmf
is not present), look
for the files in several directories where they often reside. If either
method is successful, set the shell variables x_includes
and
x_libraries
to their locations, unless they are in directories
the compiler searches by default.
If both methods fail, or the user gave the command line option
`--without-x', set the shell variable no_x
to `yes';
otherwise set it to the empty string.
AC_PATH_X
. It adds the C compiler flags
that X needs to output variable X_CFLAGS
, and the X linker flags
to X_LIBS
. Define X_DISPLAY_MISSING
if X is not
available.
This macro also checks for special libraries that some systems need in
order to compile X programs. It adds any that the system needs to
output variable X_EXTRA_LIBS
. And it checks for special X11R6
libraries that need to be linked with before `-lX11', and adds
any found to the output variable X_PRE_LIBS
.
interpval
; it will be set to `yes'
if the system supports `#!', `no' if not.
CC
. Define
_FILE_OFFSET_BITS
and _LARGE_FILES
if necessary.
Large-file support can be disabled by configuring with the `--disable-largefile' option.
If you use this macro, check that your program works even when
off_t
is longer than long
, since this is common when
large-file support is enabled. For example, it is not correct to print
an arbitrary off_t
value X
with printf ("%ld",
(long) X)
.
HAVE_LONG_FILE_NAMES
.
ac_cv_sys_posix_termios
to
`yes'. If not, set the variable to `no'.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
The following macros check for certain operating systems that need special treatment for some programs, due to exceptional oddities in their header files or libraries. These macros are warts; they will be replaced by a more systematic approach, based on the functions they make available or the environments they provide.
_ALL_SOURCE
. Allows the use of some BSD
functions. Should be called before any macros that run the C compiler.
_GNU_SOURCE
.
Allows the use of some GNU functions. Should be called
before any macros that run the C compiler.
LIBS
if necessary for POSIX facilities. Call this
after AC_PROG_CC
and before any other macros that use POSIX
interfaces. INTERACTIVE UNIX is no longer sold, and Sun says that
they will drop support for it on 2006-07-23, so this macro is becoming
obsolescent.
_MINIX
and _POSIX_SOURCE
and define
_POSIX_1_SOURCE
to be 2. This allows the use of POSIX
facilities. Should be called before any macros that run the C compiler.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
If the existing feature tests don't do something you need, you have to write new ones. These macros are the building blocks. They provide ways for other macros to check whether various kinds of features are available and report the results.
This chapter contains some suggestions and some of the reasons why the existing tests are written the way they are. You can also learn a lot about how to write Autoconf tests by looking at the existing ones. If something goes wrong in one or more of the Autoconf tests, this information can help you understand the assumptions behind them, which might help you figure out how to best solve the problem.
These macros check the output of the compiler system of the current language (see section 6.1 Language Choice). They do not cache the results of their tests for future use (see section 7.3 Caching Results), because they don't know enough about the information they are checking for to generate a cache variable name. They also do not print any messages, for the same reason. The checks for particular kinds of features call these macros and do cache their results and print messages about what they're checking for.
When you write a feature test that could be applicable to more than one software package, the best thing to do is encapsulate it in a new macro. See section 9. Writing Autoconf Macros, for how to do that.
6.1 Language Choice Selecting which language to use for testing 6.2 Writing Test Programs Forging source files for compilers 6.3 Running the Preprocessor Detecting preprocessor symbols 6.4 Running the Compiler Detecting language or header features 6.5 Running the Linker Detecting library features 6.6 Checking Run Time Behavior Testing for run-time features 6.7 Systemology A zoology of operating systems 6.8 Multiple Cases Tests for several possible values
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Autoconf-generated configure
scripts check for the C compiler and
its features by default. Packages that use other programming languages
(maybe more than one, e.g., C and C++) need to test features of the
compilers for the respective languages. The following macros determine
which programming language is used in the subsequent tests in
`configure.ac'.
Supported languages are:
CC
and CPP
and use extension
`.c' for test programs.
CXX
and CXXCPP
and use
extension `.C' for test programs.
F77
and use extension `.f' for
test programs.
AC_LANG
) on a stack, and
then select the language. Use this macro and AC_LANG_POP
in macros that need to temporarily switch to a particular language.
AC_LANG_PUSH
, and remove it from the stack.
If given, language specifies the language we just quit. It is a good idea to specify it when it's known (which should be the case...), since Autoconf will detect inconsistencies.
AC_LANG_PUSH(Fortran 77) # Perform some tests on Fortran 77. # ... AC_LANG_POP(Fortran 77) |
AC_REQUIRE
(see section 9.4.1 Prerequisite Macros) with an
argument of either AC_PROG_CPP
or AC_PROG_CXXCPP
,
depending on which language is current.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Autoconf tests follow is common scheme: feeding some program with some input, and most of the time, feeding a compiler with some source file. This section is dedicated to these source samples.
6.2.1 Guidelines for Test Programs General rules for writing test programs 6.2.2 Test Functions Avoiding pitfalls in test programs 6.2.3 Generating Sources Source program boilerplate
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
The most important rule to follow when writing testing samples is:
This motto means that testing samples must be written with the same strictness as real programs are written. In particular, you should avoid "shortcuts" and simplifications.
Don't just play with the preprocessor if you want to prepare a
compilation. For instance, using cpp
to check if a header is
functional might let your configure
accept a header which will
cause some compiler error. Do not hesitate checking header with
other headers included before, especially required headers.
Make sure the symbols you use are properly defined, i.e., refrain for simply declaring a function yourself instead of including the proper header.
Test programs should not write anything to the standard output. They
should return 0 if the test succeeds, nonzero otherwise, so that success
can be distinguished easily from a core dump or other failure;
segmentation violations and other failures produce a nonzero exit
status. Test programs should exit
, not return
, from
main
, because on some systems (old Suns, at least) the argument
to return
in main
is ignored.
Test programs can use #if
or #ifdef
to check the values of
preprocessor macros defined by tests that have already run. For
example, if you call AC_HEADER_STDC
, then later on in
`configure.ac' you can have a test program that includes an
ANSI C header file conditionally:
#if STDC_HEADERS # include <stdlib.h> #endif |
If a test program needs to use or create a data file, give it a name
that starts with `conftest', such as `conftest.data'. The
configure
script cleans up by running `rm -rf conftest*'
after running test programs and if the script is interrupted.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Function declarations in test programs should have a prototype conditionalized for C++. In practice, though, test programs rarely need functions that take arguments.
#ifdef __cplusplus foo (int i) #else foo (i) int i; #endif |
Functions that test programs declare should also be conditionalized for C++, which requires `extern "C"' prototypes. Make sure to not include any header files containing clashing prototypes.
#ifdef __cplusplus extern "C" void *malloc (size_t); #else void *malloc (); #endif |
If a test program calls a function with invalid parameters (just to see
whether it exists), organize the program to ensure that it never invokes
that function. You can do this by calling it in another function that is
never invoked. You can't do it by putting it after a call to
exit
, because GCC version 2 knows that exit
never returns
and optimizes out any code that follows it in the same block.
If you include any header files, be sure to call the functions
relevant to them with the correct number of arguments, even if they are
just 0, to avoid compilation errors due to prototypes. GCC version 2
has internal prototypes for several functions that it automatically
inlines; for example, memcpy
. To avoid errors when checking for
them, either pass them the correct number of arguments or redeclare them
with a different return type (such as char
).
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Autoconf provides a set of macros that can be used to generate test source files. They are written to be language generic, i.e., they actually depend on the current language (see section 6.1 Language Choice) to "format" the output properly.
Note that the source is evaluated exactly once, like regular Autoconf macro arguments, and therefore (i) you may pass a macro invocation, (ii) if not, be sure to double quote if needed.
AC_DEFINE
performed so far.
For instance executing (observe the double quotation!):
AC_INIT(Autoconf Documentation, 2.57, bug-autoconf@gnu.org) AC_DEFINE([HELLO_WORLD], ["Hello, World\n"]) AC_LANG_CONFTEST( [AC_LANG_SOURCE([[const char hw[] = "Hello, World\n";]])]) gcc -E -dD conftest.c -o - |
results in:
# 1 "conftest.c" # 1169 "configure" # 1 "confdefs.h" 1 #define PACKAGE_NAME "Autoconf Documentation" #define PACKAGE_TARNAME "autoconf-documentation" #define PACKAGE_VERSION "2.57" #define PACKAGE_STRING "Autoconf Documentation 2.57" #define PACKAGE_BUGREPORT "bug-autoconf@gnu.org" #define HELLO_WORLD "Hello, World\n" # 1170 "configure" 2 const char hw[] = "Hello, World\n"; |
main
in
C). Since it uses AC_LANG_SOURCE
, the feature of the latter are
available.
For instance:
AC_INIT(Autoconf Documentation, 2.57, bug-autoconf@gnu.org) AC_DEFINE([HELLO_WORLD], ["Hello, World\n"]) AC_LANG_CONFTEST( [AC_LANG_PROGRAM([[const char hw[] = "Hello, World\n";]], [[fputs (hw, stdout);]])]) gcc -E -dD conftest.c -o - |
results in:
# 1 "conftest.c" # 1169 "configure" # 1 "confdefs.h" 1 #define PACKAGE_NAME "Autoconf Documentation" #define PACKAGE_TARNAME "autoconf-documentation" #define PACKAGE_VERSION "2.57" #define PACKAGE_STRING "Autoconf Documentation 2.57" #define PACKAGE_BUGREPORT "bug-autoconf@gnu.org" #define HELLO_WORLD "Hello, World\n" # 1170 "configure" 2 const char hw[] = "Hello, World\n"; int main () { fputs (hw, stdout); ; return 0; } |
main
in C). Since it uses AC_LANG_PROGRAMS
, the feature
of the latter are available.
This function will probably be replaced in the feature by a version which would enable specifying the arguments. The use of this macro is not encouraged, as it violates strongly the typing system.
main
in C): a
simple (function pointer) assignment. Since it uses
AC_LANG_PROGRAMS
, the feature of the latter are available.
As AC_LANG_CALL
, this macro is documented only for completeness.
It is considered to be severely broken, and in the future will be
removed in favor of actual function calls (with properly typed
arguments).
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Sometimes one might need to run the preprocessor on some source file. Usually it is a bad idea, as you typically need to compile your project, not merely run the preprocessor on it; therefore you certainly want to run the compiler, not the preprocessor. Resist to the temptation of following the easiest path.
Nevertheless, if you need to run the preprocessor, then use
AC_PREPROC_IFELSE
.
AC_LANG_PROGRAM
and friends.
This macro uses CPPFLAGS
, but not CFLAGS
, because
`-g', `-O', etc. are not valid options to many C
preprocessors.
It is customary to report unexpected failures with
AC_MSG_FAILURE
.
For instance:
AC_INIT(Autoconf Documentation, 2.57, bug-autoconf@gnu.org) AC_DEFINE([HELLO_WORLD], ["Hello, World\n"]) AC_PREPROC_IFELSE( [AC_LANG_PROGRAM([[const char hw[] = "Hello, World\n";]], [[fputs (hw, stdout);]])], [AC_MSG_RESULT([OK])], [AC_MSG_FAILURE([unexpected preprocessor failure])]) |
results in:
checking for gcc... gcc checking for C compiler default output... a.out checking whether the C compiler works... yes checking whether we are cross compiling... no checking for suffix of executables... checking for suffix of object files... o checking whether we are using the GNU C compiler... yes checking whether gcc accepts -g... yes checking for gcc option to accept ANSI C... none needed checking how to run the C preprocessor... gcc -E OK |
The macro AC_TRY_CPP
(see section 15.4 Obsolete Macros) used to play the
role of AC_PREPROC_IFELSE
, but double quotes its argument, making
it impossible to use it to ellaborate sources. You are encouraged to
get rid of your old use of the macro AC_TRY_CPP
in favor of
AC_PREPROC_IFELSE
, but, in the first place, are you sure you need
to run the preprocessor and not the compiler?
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
To check for a syntax feature of the (C, C++, or Fortran 77) compiler,
such as whether it recognizes a certain keyword, or simply to try some
library feature, use AC_COMPILE_IFELSE
to try to compile a small
program that uses that feature.
AC_LANG_PROGRAM
and friends.
This macro uses CFLAGS
or CXXFLAGS
if either C or C++ is
the currently selected language, as well as CPPFLAGS
, when
compiling. If Fortran 77 is the currently selected language then
FFLAGS
will be used when compiling.
It is customary to report unexpected failures with
AC_MSG_FAILURE
. This macro does not try to link; use
AC_LINK_IFELSE
if you need to do that (see section 6.5 Running the Linker).
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
To check for a library, a function, or a global variable, Autoconf
configure
scripts try to compile and link a small program that
uses it. This is unlike Metaconfig, which by default uses nm
or
ar
on the C library to try to figure out which functions are
available. Trying to link with the function is usually a more reliable
approach because it avoids dealing with the variations in the options
and output formats of nm
and ar
and in the location of the
standard libraries. It also allows configuring for cross-compilation or
checking a function's run-time behavior if needed. On the other hand,
it can be slower than scanning the libraries once, but accuracy is more
important than speed.
AC_LINK_IFELSE
is used to compile test programs to test for
functions and global variables. It is also used by AC_CHECK_LIB
to check for libraries (see section 5.4 Library Files), by adding the library being
checked for to LIBS
temporarily and trying to link a small
program.
AC_LANG_PROGRAM
and friends.
This macro uses CFLAGS
or CXXFLAGS
if either C or C++ is
the currently selected language, as well as CPPFLAGS
, when
compiling. If Fortran 77 is the currently selected language then
FFLAGS
will be used when compiling.
It is customary to report unexpected failures with
AC_MSG_FAILURE
. This macro does not try to execute the program;
use AC_RUN_IFELSE
if you need to do that (see section 6.6 Checking Run Time Behavior).
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Sometimes you need to find out how a system performs at run time, such as whether a given function has a certain capability or bug. If you can, make such checks when your program runs instead of when it is configured. You can check for things like the machine's endianness when your program initializes itself.
If you really need to test for a run-time behavior while configuring,
you can write a test program to determine the result, and compile and
run it using AC_RUN_IFELSE
. Avoid running test programs if
possible, because this prevents people from configuring your package for
cross-compiling.
The input can be made by AC_LANG_PROGRAM
and friends. This
macro uses CFLAGS
or CXXFLAGS
, CPPFLAGS
,
LDFLAGS
, and LIBS
If the compiler being used does not produce executables that run on the
system where configure
is being run, then the test program is
not run. If the optional shell commands action-if-cross-compiling
are given, they are run instead. Otherwise, configure
prints
an error message and exits.
In the action-if-false section, the exit status of the program is available in the shell variable `$?', but be very careful to limit yourself to positive values smaller than 127; bigger values should be saved into a file by the program. Note also that you have simply no guarantee that this exit status is issued by the program, or by the failure of its compilation. In other words, use this feature if sadist only, it was reestablished because the Autoconf maintainers grew tired of receiving "bug reports".
It is customary to report unexpected failures with
AC_MSG_FAILURE
.
Try to provide a pessimistic default value to use when cross-compiling
makes run-time tests impossible. You do this by passing the optional
last argument to AC_RUN_IFELSE
. autoconf
prints a
warning message when creating configure
each time it
encounters a call to AC_RUN_IFELSE
with no
action-if-cross-compiling argument given. You may ignore the
warning, though users will not be able to configure your package for
cross-compiling. A few of the macros distributed with Autoconf produce
this warning message.
To configure for cross-compiling you can also choose a value for those parameters based on the canonical system name (see section 11. Manual Configuration). Alternatively, set up a test results cache file with the correct values for the host system (see section 7.3 Caching Results).
To provide a default for calls of AC_RUN_IFELSE
that are embedded
in other macros, including a few of the ones that come with Autoconf,
you can test whether the shell variable cross_compiling
is set to
`yes', and then use an alternate method to get the results instead
of calling the macros.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
This section aims at presenting some systems and pointers to documentation. It may help you addressing particular problems reported by users.
The Rosetta Stone for Unix contains a lot of interesting crossed information on various Unices.
That's all dependent on whether the file system is a UFS (case sensitive) or HFS+ (case preserving). By default Apple wants you to install the OS on HFS+. Unfortunately, there are some pieces of software which really need to be built on UFS. We may want to rebuild Darwin to have both UFS and HFS+ available (and put the /local/build tree on the UFS).
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Some operations are accomplished in several possible ways, depending on the UNIX variant. Checking for them essentially requires a "case statement". Autoconf does not directly provide one; however, it is easy to simulate by using a shell variable to keep track of whether a way to perform the operation has been found yet.
Here is an example that uses the shell variable fstype
to keep
track of whether the remaining cases need to be checked.
AC_MSG_CHECKING([how to get file system type]) fstype=no # The order of these tests is important. AC_COMPILE_IFELSE([AC_LANG_PROGRAM([[#include <sys/statvfs.h> #include <sys/fstyp.h>]])], [AC_DEFINE(FSTYPE_STATVFS) fstype=SVR4]) if test $fstype = no; then AC_COMPILE_IFELSE([AC_LANG_PROGRAM([[#include <sys/statfs.h> #include <sys/fstyp.h>]])], [AC_DEFINE(FSTYPE_USG_STATFS) fstype=SVR3]) fi if test $fstype = no; then AC_COMPILE_IFELSE([AC_LANG_PROGRAM([[#include <sys/statfs.h> #include <sys/vmount.h>]])]), [AC_DEFINE(FSTYPE_AIX_STATFS) fstype=AIX]) fi # (more cases omitted here) AC_MSG_RESULT([$fstype]) |
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Once configure
has determined whether a feature exists, what can
it do to record that information? There are four sorts of things it can
do: define a C preprocessor symbol, set a variable in the output files,
save the result in a cache file for future configure
runs, and
print a message letting the user know the result of the test.
7.1 Defining C Preprocessor Symbols Defining C preprocessor symbols 7.2 Setting Output Variables Replacing variables in output files 7.3 Caching Results Speeding up subsequent configure
runs7.4 Printing Messages Notifying configure
users
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
A common action to take in response to a feature test is to define a C
preprocessor symbol indicating the results of the test. That is done by
calling AC_DEFINE
or AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED
.
By default, AC_OUTPUT
places the symbols defined by these macros
into the output variable DEFS
, which contains an option
`-Dsymbol=value' for each symbol defined. Unlike in
Autoconf version 1, there is no variable DEFS
defined while
configure
is running. To check whether Autoconf macros have
already defined a certain C preprocessor symbol, test the value of the
appropriate cache variable, as in this example:
AC_CHECK_FUNC(vprintf, [AC_DEFINE(HAVE_VPRINTF)]) if test "$ac_cv_func_vprintf" != yes; then AC_CHECK_FUNC(_doprnt, [AC_DEFINE(HAVE_DOPRNT)]) fi |
If AC_CONFIG_HEADERS
has been called, then instead of creating
DEFS
, AC_OUTPUT
creates a header file by substituting the
correct values into #define
statements in a template file.
See section 4.8 Configuration Header Files, for more information about this kind of
output.
AC_CONFIG_HEADERS
it should not contain any `#'
characters, as make
tends to eat them. To use a shell variable
(which you need to do in order to define a value containing the M4 quote
characters `[' or `]'), use AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED
instead.
description is only useful if you are using
AC_CONFIG_HEADERS
. In this case, description is put into
the generated `config.h.in' as the comment before the macro define.
The following example defines the C preprocessor variable
EQUATION
to be the string constant `"$a > $b"':
AC_DEFINE(EQUATION, "$a > $b") |
If neither value nor description are given, then value defaults to 1 instead of to the empty string. This is for backwards compatibility with older versions of Autoconf, but this usage is obsolescent and may be withdrawn in future versions of Autoconf.
AC_DEFINE
, but three shell expansions are
performed--once--on variable and value: variable expansion
(`$'), command substitution (``'), and backslash escaping
(`\'). Single and double quote characters in the value have no
special meaning. Use this macro instead of AC_DEFINE
when
variable or value is a shell variable. Examples:
AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(config_machfile, "$machfile") AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(GETGROUPS_T, $ac_cv_type_getgroups) AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED($ac_tr_hdr) |
Due to a syntactical bizarreness of the Bourne shell, do not use
semicolons to separate AC_DEFINE
or AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED
calls from other macro calls or shell code; that can cause syntax errors
in the resulting configure
script. Use either spaces or
newlines. That is, do this:
AC_CHECK_HEADER(elf.h, [AC_DEFINE(SVR4) LIBS="$LIBS -lelf"]) |
or this:
AC_CHECK_HEADER(elf.h, [AC_DEFINE(SVR4) LIBS="$LIBS -lelf"]) |
instead of this:
AC_CHECK_HEADER(elf.h, [AC_DEFINE(SVR4); LIBS="$LIBS -lelf"]) |
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Another way to record the results of tests is to set output
variables, which are shell variables whose values are substituted into
files that configure
outputs. The two macros below create new
output variables. See section 4.7.1 Preset Output Variables, for a list of output
variables that are always available.
AC_OUTPUT
substitute the variable variable into output files (typically one
or more `Makefile's). This means that AC_OUTPUT
will
replace instances of `@variable@' in input files with the
value that the shell variable variable has when AC_OUTPUT
is called. This value of variable should not contain literal
newlines.
If value is given, in addition assign it to variable.
AC_OUTPUT
insert (without substitutions) the contents of the file
named by shell variable variable into output files. This means
that AC_OUTPUT
will replace instances of
`@variable@' in output files (such as `Makefile.in')
with the contents of the file that the shell variable variable
names when AC_OUTPUT
is called. Set the variable to
`/dev/null' for cases that do not have a file to insert.
This macro is useful for inserting `Makefile' fragments containing
special dependencies or other make
directives for particular host
or target types into `Makefile's. For example, `configure.ac'
could contain:
AC_SUBST_FILE(host_frag) host_frag=$srcdir/conf/sun4.mh |
and then a `Makefile.in' could contain:
@host_frag@ |
Running configure
in varying environments can be extremely
dangerous. If for instance the user runs `CC=bizarre-cc
./configure', then the cache, `config.h', and many other output
files will depend upon bizarre-cc
being the C compiler. If
for some reason the user runs ./configure
again, or if it is
run via `./config.status --recheck', (See section 4.7.4 Automatic Remaking,
and see section 14. Recreating a Configuration), then the configuration can be
inconsistent, composed of results depending upon two different
compilers.
Environment variables that affect this situation, such as `CC'
above, are called precious variables, and can be declared as such
by AC_ARG_VAR
.
Being precious means that
AC_SUBST
'd.
configure
was launched is
saved in the cache, including if it was not specified on the command
line but via the environment. Indeed, while configure
can
notice the definition of CC
in `./configure CC=bizarre-cc',
it is impossible to notice it in `CC=bizarre-cc ./configure',
which, unfortunately, is what most users do.
We emphasize that it is the initial value of variable which
is saved, not that found during the execution of configure
.
Indeed, specifying `./configure FOO=foo' and letting
`./configure' guess that FOO
is foo
can be two very
different runs.
configure
runs. For instance:
$ ./configure --silent --config-cache $ CC=cc ./configure --silent --config-cache configure: error: `CC' was not set in the previous run configure: error: changes in the environment can compromise \ the build configure: error: run `make distclean' and/or \ `rm config.cache' and start over |
and similarly if the variable is unset, or if its content is changed.
$ CC=/usr/bin/cc ./configure undeclared_var=raboof --silent $ ./config.status --recheck running /bin/sh ./configure undeclared_var=raboof --silent \ CC=/usr/bin/cc --no-create --no-recursion |
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
To avoid checking for the same features repeatedly in various
configure
scripts (or in repeated runs of one script),
configure
can optionally save the results of many checks in a
cache file (see section 7.3.2 Cache Files). If a configure
script
runs with caching enabled and finds a cache file, it reads the results
of previous runs from the cache and avoids rerunning those checks. As a
result, configure
can then run much faster than if it had to
perform all of the checks every time.
configure
was not given the `--quiet' or
`--silent' option, print a message saying that the result was
cached; otherwise, run the shell commands commands-to-set-it. If
the shell commands are run to determine the value, the value will be
saved in the cache file just before configure
creates its output
files. See section 7.3.1 Cache Variable Names, for how to choose the name of the
cache-id variable.
The commands-to-set-it must have no side effects except for setting the variable cache-id, see below.
AC_CACHE_VAL
that takes care of printing the
messages. This macro provides a convenient shorthand for the most
common way to use these macros. It calls AC_MSG_CHECKING
for
message, then AC_CACHE_VAL
with the cache-id and
commands arguments, and AC_MSG_RESULT
with cache-id.
The commands-to-set-it must have no side effects except for setting the variable cache-id, see below.
It is very common to find buggy macros using AC_CACHE_VAL
or
AC_CACHE_CHECK
, because people are tempted to call
AC_DEFINE
in the commands-to-set-it. Instead, the code that
follows the call to AC_CACHE_VAL
should call
AC_DEFINE
, by examining the value of the cache variable. For
instance, the following macro is broken:
AC_DEFUN([AC_SHELL_TRUE], [AC_CACHE_CHECK([whether true(1) works], [ac_cv_shell_true_works], [ac_cv_shell_true_works=no true && ac_cv_shell_true_works=yes if test $ac_cv_shell_true_works = yes; then AC_DEFINE([TRUE_WORKS], 1 [Define if `true(1)' works properly.]) fi]) ]) |
This fails if the cache is enabled: the second time this macro is run,
TRUE_WORKS
will not be defined. The proper implementation
is:
AC_DEFUN([AC_SHELL_TRUE], [AC_CACHE_CHECK([whether true(1) works], [ac_cv_shell_true_works], [ac_cv_shell_true_works=no true && ac_cv_shell_true_works=yes]) if test $ac_cv_shell_true_works = yes; then AC_DEFINE([TRUE_WORKS], 1 [Define if `true(1)' works properly.]) fi ]) |
Also, commands-to-set-it should not print any messages, for
example with AC_MSG_CHECKING
; do that before calling
AC_CACHE_VAL
, so the messages are printed regardless of whether
the results of the check are retrieved from the cache or determined by
running the shell commands.
7.3.1 Cache Variable Names Shell variables used in caches 7.3.2 Cache Files Files configure
uses for caching7.3.3 Cache Checkpointing Loading and saving the cache file
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
The names of cache variables should have the following format:
package-prefix_cv_value-type_specific-value_[additional-options] |
for example, `ac_cv_header_stat_broken' or `ac_cv_prog_gcc_traditional'. The parts of the variable name are:
_cv_
The values assigned to cache variables may not contain newlines. Usually, their values will be Boolean (`yes' or `no') or the names of files or functions; so this is not an important restriction.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
A cache file is a shell script that caches the results of configure tests run on one system so they can be shared between configure scripts and configure runs. It is not useful on other systems. If its contents are invalid for some reason, the user may delete or edit it.
By default, configure
uses no cache file (technically, it uses
`--cache-file=/dev/null'), to avoid problems caused by accidental
use of stale cache files.
To enable caching, configure
accepts `--config-cache' (or
`-C') to cache results in the file `config.cache'.
Alternatively, `--cache-file=file' specifies that
file be the cache file. The cache file is created if it does not
exist already. When configure
calls configure
scripts in
subdirectories, it uses the `--cache-file' argument so that they
share the same cache. See section 4.11 Configuring Other Packages in Subdirectories, for information on
configuring subdirectories with the AC_CONFIG_SUBDIRS
macro.
`config.status' only pays attention to the cache file if it is
given the `--recheck' option, which makes it rerun
configure
.
It is wrong to try to distribute cache files for particular system types. There is too much room for error in doing that, and too much administrative overhead in maintaining them. For any features that can't be guessed automatically, use the standard method of the canonical system type and linking files (see section 11. Manual Configuration).
The site initialization script can specify a site-wide cache file to
use, instead of the usual per-program cache. In this case, the cache
file will gradually accumulate information whenever someone runs a new
configure
script. (Running configure
merges the new cache
results with the existing cache file.) This may cause problems,
however, if the system configuration (e.g., the installed libraries or
compilers) changes and the stale cache file is not deleted.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
If your configure script, or a macro called from `configure.ac', happens
to abort the configure process, it may be useful to checkpoint the cache
a few times at key points using AC_CACHE_SAVE
. Doing so will
reduce the amount of time it takes to re-run the configure script with
(hopefully) the error that caused the previous abort corrected.
AC_INIT
.
AC_OUTPUT
, but it can be quite useful to call
AC_CACHE_SAVE
at key points in `configure.ac'.
For instance:
... AC_INIT, etc. ... # Checks for programs. AC_PROG_CC AC_PROG_GCC_TRADITIONAL ... more program checks ... AC_CACHE_SAVE # Checks for libraries. AC_CHECK_LIB(nsl, gethostbyname) AC_CHECK_LIB(socket, connect) ... more lib checks ... AC_CACHE_SAVE # Might abort... AM_PATH_GTK(1.0.2,, [AC_MSG_ERROR([GTK not in path])]) AM_PATH_GTKMM(0.9.5,, [AC_MSG_ERROR([GTK not in path])]) ... AC_OUTPUT, etc. ... |
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
configure
scripts need to give users running them several kinds
of information. The following macros print messages in ways appropriate
for each kind. The arguments to all of them get enclosed in shell
double quotes, so the shell performs variable and back-quote
substitution on them.
These macros are all wrappers around the echo
shell command.
configure
scripts should rarely need to run echo
directly
to print messages for the user. Using these macros makes it easy to
change how and when each kind of message is printed; such changes need
only be made to the macro definitions and all of the callers will change
automatically.
To diagnose static issues, i.e., when autoconf
is run, see
9.3 Reporting Messages.
configure
is checking for a particular
feature. This macro prints a message that starts with `checking '
and ends with `...' and no newline. It must be followed by a call
to AC_MSG_RESULT
to print the result of the check and the
newline. The feature-description should be something like
`whether the Fortran compiler accepts C++ comments' or `for
c89'.
This macro prints nothing if configure
is run with the
`--quiet' or `--silent' option.
AC_MSG_CHECKING
, and the result-description should be
the completion of the message printed by the call to
AC_MSG_CHECKING
.
This macro prints nothing if configure
is run with the
`--quiet' or `--silent' option.
AC_MSG_NOTICE([checking if stack overflow is detectable]) |
This macro prints nothing if configure
is run with the
`--quiet' or `--silent' option.
configure
from
completing. This macro prints an error message to the standard error
output and exits configure
with exit-status (1 by default).
error-description should be something like `invalid value
$HOME for \$HOME'.
The error-description should start with a lower-case letter, and "cannot" is preferred to "can't".
AC_MSG_ERROR
wrapper notifies the user of an error that
prevents configure
from completing and that additional
details are provided in `config.log'. This is typically used when
abnormal results are found during a compilation.
configure
user of a possible problem. This macro
prints the message to the standard error output; configure
continues running afterward, so macros that call AC_MSG_WARN
should
provide a default (back-up) behavior for the situations they warn about.
problem-description should be something like `ln -s seems to
make hard links'.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Autoconf is written on top of two layers: M4sugar, which provides convenient macros for pure M4 programming, and M4sh, which provides macros dedicated to shell script generation.
As of this version of Autoconf, these two layers are still experimental, and their interface might change in the future. As a matter of fact, anything that is not documented must not be used.
8.1 M4 Quotation Protecting macros from unwanted expansion 8.2 Using autom4te
The Autoconf executables backbone 8.3 Programming in M4sugar Convenient pure M4 macros 8.4 Programming in M4sh Common shell Constructs
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
The most common problem with existing macros is an improper quotation. This section, which users of Autoconf can skip, but which macro writers must read, first justifies the quotation scheme that was chosen for Autoconf and then ends with a rule of thumb. Understanding the former helps one to follow the latter.
8.1.1 Active Characters Characters that change the behavior of M4 8.1.2 One Macro Call Quotation and one macro call 8.1.3 Quotation and Nested Macros Macros calling macros 8.1.4 changequote
is EvilWorse than INTERCAL: M4 + changequote 8.1.5 Quadrigraphs Another way to escape special characters 8.1.6 Quotation Rule Of Thumb One parenthesis, one quote
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
To fully understand where proper quotation is important, you first need to know what the special characters are in Autoconf: `#' introduces a comment inside which no macro expansion is performed, `,' separates arguments, `[' and `]' are the quotes themselves, and finally `(' and `)' (which M4 tries to match by pairs).
In order to understand the delicate case of macro calls, we first have to present some obvious failures. Below they are "obvious-ified", but when you find them in real life, they are usually in disguise.
Comments, introduced by a hash and running up to the newline, are opaque tokens to the top level: active characters are turned off, and there is no macro expansion:
# define([def], ine) =># define([def], ine) |
Each time there can be a macro expansion, there is a quotation expansion, i.e., one level of quotes is stripped:
int tab[10]; =>int tab10; [int tab[10];] =>int tab[10]; |
Without this in mind, the reader will try hopelessly to use her macro
array
:
define([array], [int tab[10];]) array =>int tab10; [array] =>array |
How can you correctly output the intended results(2)?
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Let's proceed on the interaction between active characters and macros with this small macro, which just returns its first argument:
define([car], [$1]) |
The two pairs of quotes above are not part of the arguments of
define
; rather, they are understood by the top level when it
tries to find the arguments of define
. Therefore, it is
equivalent to write:
define(car, $1) |
But, while it is acceptable for a `configure.ac' to avoid unnecessary quotes, it is bad practice for Autoconf macros which must both be more robust and also advocate perfect style.
At the top level, there are only two possibilities: either you quote or you don't:
car(foo, bar, baz) =>foo [car(foo, bar, baz)] =>car(foo, bar, baz) |
Let's pay attention to the special characters:
car(#) error-->EOF in argument list |
The closing parenthesis is hidden in the comment; with a hypothetical quoting, the top level understood it this way:
car([#)] |
Proper quotation, of course, fixes the problem:
car([#]) =># |
The reader will easily understand the following examples:
car(foo, bar) =>foo car([foo, bar]) =>foo, bar car((foo, bar)) =>(foo, bar) car([(foo], [bar)]) =>(foo car([], []) => car([[]], [[]]) =>[] |
With this in mind, we can explore the cases where macros invoke macros....
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
The examples below use the following macros:
define([car], [$1]) define([active], [ACT, IVE]) define([array], [int tab[10]]) |
Each additional embedded macro call introduces other possible interesting quotations:
car(active) =>ACT car([active]) =>ACT, IVE car([[active]]) =>active |
In the first case, the top level looks for the arguments of car
,
and finds `active'. Because M4 evaluates its arguments
before applying the macro, `active' is expanded, which results in:
car(ACT, IVE) =>ACT |
In the second case, the top level gives `active' as first and only
argument of car
, which results in:
active =>ACT, IVE |
i.e., the argument is evaluated after the macro that invokes it.
In the third case, car
receives `[active]', which results in:
[active] =>active |
exactly as we already saw above.
The example above, applied to a more realistic example, gives:
car(int tab[10];) =>int tab10; car([int tab[10];]) =>int tab10; car([[int tab[10];]]) =>int tab[10]; |
Huh? The first case is easily understood, but why is the second wrong,
and the third right? To understand that, you must know that after
M4 expands a macro, the resulting text is immediately subjected
to macro expansion and quote removal. This means that the quote removal
occurs twice--first before the argument is passed to the car
macro, and second after the car
macro expands to the first
argument.
As the author of the Autoconf macro car
, you then consider it to
be incorrect that your users have to double-quote the arguments of
car
, so you "fix" your macro. Let's call it qar
for
quoted car:
define([qar], [[$1]]) |
and check that qar
is properly fixed:
qar([int tab[10];]) =>int tab[10]; |
Ahhh! That's much better.
But note what you've done: now that the arguments are literal strings, if the user wants to use the results of expansions as arguments, she has to use an unquoted macro call:
qar(active) =>ACT |
where she wanted to reproduce what she used to do with car
:
car([active]) =>ACT, IVE |
Worse yet: she wants to use a macro that produces a set of cpp
macros:
define([my_includes], [#include <stdio.h>]) car([my_includes]) =>#include <stdio.h> qar(my_includes) error-->EOF in argument list |
This macro, qar
, because it double quotes its arguments, forces
its users to leave their macro calls unquoted, which is dangerous.
Commas and other active symbols are interpreted by M4 before
they are given to the macro, often not in the way the users expect.
Also, because qar
behaves differently from the other macros,
it's an exception that should be avoided in Autoconf.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
changequote
is Evil
The temptation is often high to bypass proper quotation, in particular
when it's late at night. Then, many experienced Autoconf hackers
finally surrender to the dark side of the force and use the ultimate
weapon: changequote
.
The M4 builtin changequote
belongs to a set of primitives that
allow one to adjust the syntax of the language to adjust it to one's
needs. For instance, by default M4 uses ``' and `'' as
quotes, but in the context of shell programming (and actually of most
programming languages), that's about the worst choice one can make:
because of strings and back-quoted expressions in shell code (such as
`'this'' and ``that`'), because of literal characters in usual
programming languages (as in `'0''), there are many unbalanced
``' and `''. Proper M4 quotation then becomes a nightmare, if
not impossible. In order to make M4 useful in such a context, its
designers have equipped it with changequote
, which makes it
possible to choose another pair of quotes. M4sugar, M4sh, Autoconf, and
Autotest all have chosen to use `[' and `]'. Not especially
because they are unlikely characters, but because they are
characters unlikely to be unbalanced.
There are other magic primitives, such as changecom
to specify
what syntactic forms are comments (it is common to see
`changecom(<!--, -->)' when M4 is used to produce HTML pages),
changeword
and changesyntax
to change other syntactic
details (such as the character to denote the n-th argument, `$' by
default, the parenthesis around arguments etc.).
These primitives are really meant to make M4 more useful for specific
domains: they should be considered like command line options:
`--quotes', `--comments', `--words', and
--syntax
. Nevertheless, they are implemented as M4 builtins, as
it makes M4 libraries self contained (no need for additional options).
There lies the problem....
The problem is that it is then tempting to use them in the middle of an M4 script, as opposed to its initialization. This, if not carefully thought out, can lead to disastrous effects: you are changing the language in the middle of the execution. Changing and restoring the syntax is often not enough: if you happened to invoke macros in between, these macros will be lost, as the current syntax will probably not be the one they were implemented with.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
When writing an Autoconf macro you may occasionally need to generate special characters that are difficult to express with the standard Autoconf quoting rules. For example, you may need to output the regular expression `[^[]', which matches any character other than `['. This expression contains unbalanced brackets so it cannot be put easily into an M4 macro.
You can work around this problem by using one of the following quadrigraphs:
Quadrigraphs are replaced at a late stage of the translation process,
after m4
is run, so they do not get in the way of M4 quoting.
For example, the string `^@<:@', independently of its quotation,
will appear as `^[' in the output.
The empty quadrigraph can be used:
Trailing spaces are smashed by autom4te
. This is a feature.
For instance `@<@&t@:@' produces `@<:@'.
For instance you might want to mention AC_FOO
in a comment, while
still being sure that autom4te
will still catch unexpanded
`AC_*'. Then write `AC@&t@_FOO'.
The name `@&t@' was suggested by Paul Eggert:
I should give some credit to the `@&t@' pun. The `&' is my own invention, but the `t' came from the source code of the ALGOL68C compiler, written by Steve Bourne (of Bourne shell fame), and which used `mt' to denote the empty string. In C, it would have looked like something like:
char const mt[] = "";but of course the source code was written in Algol 68.
I don't know where he got `mt' from: it could have been his own invention, and I suppose it could have been a common pun around the Cambridge University computer lab at the time.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
To conclude, the quotation rule of thumb is:
Never over-quote, never under-quote, in particular in the definition of macros. In the few places where the macros need to use brackets (usually in C program text or regular expressions), properly quote the arguments!
It is common to read Autoconf programs with snippets like:
AC_TRY_LINK( changequote(<<, >>)dnl <<#include <time.h> #ifndef tzname /* For SGI. */ extern char *tzname[]; /* RS6000 and others reject char **tzname. */ #endif>>, changequote([, ])dnl [atoi (*tzname);], ac_cv_var_tzname=yes, ac_cv_var_tzname=no) |
which is incredibly useless since AC_TRY_LINK
is already
double quoting, so you just need:
AC_TRY_LINK( [#include <time.h> #ifndef tzname /* For SGI. */ extern char *tzname[]; /* RS6000 and others reject char **tzname. */ #endif], [atoi (*tzname);], [ac_cv_var_tzname=yes], [ac_cv_var_tzname=no]) |
The M4-fluent reader will note that these two examples are rigorously equivalent, since M4 swallows both the `changequote(<<, >>)' and `<<' `>>' when it collects the arguments: these quotes are not part of the arguments!
Simplified, the example above is just doing this:
changequote(<<, >>)dnl <<[]>> changequote([, ])dnl |
instead of simply:
[[]] |
With macros that do not double quote their arguments (which is the rule), double-quote the (risky) literals:
AC_LINK_IFELSE([AC_LANG_PROGRAM( [[#include <time.h> #ifndef tzname /* For SGI. */ extern char *tzname[]; /* RS6000 and others reject char **tzname. */ #endif]], [atoi (*tzname);])], [ac_cv_var_tzname=yes], [ac_cv_var_tzname=no]) |
See section 8.1.5 Quadrigraphs, for what to do if you run into a hopeless case where quoting does not suffice.
When you create a configure
script using newly written macros,
examine it carefully to check whether you need to add more quotes in
your macros. If one or more words have disappeared in the M4
output, you need more quotes. When in doubt, quote.
However, it's also possible to put on too many layers of quotes. If
this happens, the resulting configure
script will contain
unexpanded macros. The autoconf
program checks for this problem
by doing `grep AC_ configure'.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
autom4te
The Autoconf suite, including M4sugar, M4sh, and Autotest, in addition
to Autoconf per se, heavily rely on M4. All these different uses
revealed common needs factored into a layer over m4
:
autom4te
(3).
autom4te
should basically considered as a replacement of
m4
itself.
8.2.1 Invoking autom4te
A GNU M4 wrapper 8.2.2 Customizing autom4te
Customizing the Autoconf package
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
autom4te
The command line arguments are modeled after M4's:
autom4te options files |
where the files are directly passed to m4
. In addition
to the regular expansion, it handles the replacement of the quadrigraphs
(see section 8.1.5 Quadrigraphs), and of `__oline__', the current line in the
output. It supports an extended syntax for the files:
Of course, it supports the Autoconf common subset of options:
As an extension of m4
, it includes the following options:
AC_DIAGNOSE
, for a comprehensive list of categories. Special
values include:
Warnings about `syntax' are enabled by default, and the environment
variable WARNINGS
, a comma separated list of categories, is
honored. autom4te -W category
will actually
behave as if you had run:
autom4te --warnings=syntax,$WARNINGS,category |
If you want to disable autom4te
's defaults and
WARNINGS
, but (for example) enable the warnings about obsolete
constructs, you would use `-W none,obsolete'.
autom4te
displays a back trace for errors, but not for
warnings; if you want them, just pass `-W error'. For instance,
on this `configure.ac':
AC_DEFUN([INNER], [AC_RUN_IFELSE([AC_LANG_PROGRAM([exit (0)])])]) AC_DEFUN([OUTER], [INNER]) AC_INIT OUTER |
you get:
$ autom4te -l autoconf -Wcross configure.ac:8: warning: AC_RUN_IFELSE called without default \ to allow cross compiling $ autom4te -l autoconf -Wcross,error -f configure.ac:8: error: AC_RUN_IFELSE called without default \ to allow cross compiling acgeneral.m4:3044: AC_RUN_IFELSE is expanded from... configure.ac:2: INNER is expanded from... configure.ac:5: OUTER is expanded from... configure.ac:8: the top level |
file.m4f
will be
replaced with file.m4
. This helps tracing the macros which
are executed only when the files are frozen, typically
m4_define
. For instance, running:
autom4te --melt 1.m4 2.m4f 3.m4 4.m4f input.m4 |
is roughly equivalent to running:
m4 1.m4 2.m4 3.m4 4.m4 input.m4 |
while
autom4te 1.m4 2.m4f 3.m4 4.m4f input.m4 |
is equivalent to:
m4 --reload-state=4.m4f input.m4 |
autom4te
freezing is stricter
than M4's: it must produce no warnings, and no output other than empty
lines (a line with whitespace is not empty) and comments
(starting with `#'). Please, note that contrary to m4
,
this options takes no argument:
autom4te 1.m4 2.m4 3.m4 --freeze --output=3.m4f |
corresponds to
m4 1.m4 2.m4 3.m4 --freeze-state=3.m4f |
As another additional feature over m4
, autom4te
caches its results. GNU M4 is able to produce a regular
output and traces at the same time. Traces are heavily used in the
GNU Build System: autoheader
uses them to build
`config.h.in', autoreconf
to determine what
GNU Build System components are used, automake
to
"parse" `configure.ac' etc. To save the long runs of
m4
, traces are cached while performing regular expansion,
and conversely. This cache is (actually, the caches are) stored in
the directory `autom4te.cache'. It can safely be removed
at any moment (especially if for some reason autom4te
considers it is trashed).
Because traces are so important to the GNU Build System,
autom4te
provides high level tracing features as compared to
M4, and helps exploiting the cache:
The format is a regular string, with newlines if desired, and several special escape codes. It defaults to `$f:$l:$n:$%'. It can use the following special escapes:
The escape `$%' produces single-line trace outputs (unless you put newlines in the `separator'), while `$@' and `$*' do not.
See section 3.4 Using autoconf
to Create configure
, for examples of trace uses.
autoconf
preselects all the macros that
autoheader
, automake
, autoreconf
etc. will
trace, so that running m4
is not needed to trace them: the
cache suffices. This results in a huge speed-up.
Finally, autom4te
introduces the concept of Autom4te
libraries. They consists in a powerful yet extremely simple feature:
sets of combined command line arguments:
M4sugar
M4sh
Autotest
Autoconf
As an example, if Autoconf is installed in its default location, `/usr/local', running `autom4te -l m4sugar foo.m4' is strictly equivalent to running `autom4te --prepend-include /usr/local/share/autoconf m4sugar/m4sugar.m4f --warnings syntax foo.m4'. Recursive expansion applies: running `autom4te -l m4sh foo.m4' is the same as `autom4te --language M4sugar m4sugar/m4sh.m4f foo.m4', i.e., `autom4te --prepend-include /usr/local/share/autoconf m4sugar/m4sugar.m4f m4sugar/m4sh.m4f --mode 777 foo.m4'. The definition of the languages is stored in `autom4te.cfg'.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
autom4te
One can customize autom4te
via `~/.autom4te.cfg' (i.e.,
as found in the user home directory), and `./.autom4te.cfg' (i.e.,
as found in the directory from which autom4te
is run). The
order is first reading `autom4te.cfg', then `~/.autom4te.cfg',
then `./.autom4te.cfg', and finally the command line arguments.
In these text files, comments are introduced with #
, and empty
lines are ignored. Customization is performed on a per-language basis,
wrapped in between a `begin-language: "language"',
`end-language: "language"' pair.
Customizing a language stands for appending options (see section 8.2.1 Invoking autom4te
) to the current definition of the language. Options, and
more generally arguments, are introduced by `args:
arguments'. You may use the traditional shell syntax to quote the
arguments.
As an example, to disable Autoconf caches (`autom4te.cache') globally, include the following lines in `~/.autom4te.cfg':
@verbatim ## ------------------ ## ## User Preferences. ## ## ------------------ ##
begin-language: "Autoconf" args: --no-cache end-language: "Autoconf"
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
M4 by itself provides only a small, but sufficient, set of all-purpose macros. M4sugar introduces additional generic macros. Its name was coined by Lars J. Aas: "Readability And Greater Understanding Stands 4 M4sugar".
8.3.1 Redefined M4 Macros M4 builtins changed in M4sugar 8.3.2 Evaluation Macros More quotation and evaluation control 8.3.3 Forbidden Patterns Catching unexpanded macros
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
With a few exceptions, all the M4 native macros are moved in the
`m4_' pseudo-namespace, e.g., M4sugar renames define
as
m4_define
etc.
Some M4 macros are redefined, and are slightly incompatible with their native equivalent.
m4_dnl
is defined.
m4_undefine
.
m4exit
.
ifelse
.
m4_ifdef([macro], [m4_undefine([macro])]) |
to recover the behavior of the builtin.
patsubst
. The name m4_patsubst
is kept for future versions of M4sh, on top of GNU M4 which will
provide extended regular expression syntax via epatsubst
.
m4_undefine
.
regexp
. The name m4_regexp
is kept for future versions of M4sh, on top of GNU M4 which will
provide extended regular expression syntax via eregexp
.
m4wrap
.
You are encouraged to end text with `[]', so that there are
no risks that two consecutive invocations of m4_wrap
result in an
unexpected pasting of tokens, as in
m4_define([foo], [Foo]) m4_define([bar], [Bar]) m4_define([foobar], [FOOBAR]) m4_wrap([bar]) m4_wrap([foo]) =>FOOBAR |
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
The following macros give some control over the order of the evaluation by adding or removing levels of quotes. They are meant for hard-core M4 programmers.
The following example aims at emphasizing the difference between (i), not
using these macros, (ii), using m4_quote
, and (iii), using
m4_dquote
.
$ cat example.m4 # Overquote, so that quotes are visible. m4_define([show], [$[]1 = [$1], $[]@ = [$@]]) m4_divert(0)dnl show(a, b) show(m4_quote(a, b)) show(m4_dquote(a, b)) $ autom4te -l m4sugar example.m4 $1 = a, $@ = [a],[b] $1 = a,b, $@ = [a,b] $1 = [a],[b], $@ = [[a],[b]] |
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
M4sugar provides a means to define suspicious patterns, patterns describing tokens which should not be found in the output. For instance, if an Autoconf `configure' script includes tokens such as `AC_DEFINE', or `dnl', then most probably something went wrong (typically a macro was not evaluated because of overquotation).
M4sugar forbids all the tokens matching `^m4_' and `^dnl$'.
Of course, you might encounter exceptions to these generic rules, for instance you might have to refer to `$m4_flags'.
m4_pattern_forbid
pattern.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
M4sh, pronounced "mash", is aiming at producing portable Bourne shell scripts. This name was coined by Lars J. Aas, who notes that, according to the Webster's Revised Unabridged Dictionary (1913):
Mash \Mash\, n. [Akin to G. meisch, maisch, meische, maische, mash, wash, and prob. to AS. miscian to mix. See "Mix".]
- A mass of mixed ingredients reduced to a soft pulpy state by beating or pressure....
- A mixture of meal or bran and water fed to animals.
- A mess; trouble. [Obs.] --Beau. & Fl.
For the time being, it is not mature enough to be widely used.
M4sh provides portable alternatives for some common shell constructs that unfortunately are not portable in practice.
dirname
command.
mkdir
that
lack support for the `-p' option.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
When you write a feature test that could be applicable to more than one software package, the best thing to do is encapsulate it in a new macro. Here are some instructions and guidelines for writing Autoconf macros.
9.1 Macro Definitions Basic format of an Autoconf macro 9.2 Macro Names What to call your new macros 9.3 Reporting Messages Notifying autoconf
users9.4 Dependencies Between Macros What to do when macros depend on other macros 9.5 Obsoleting Macros Warning about old ways of doing things 9.6 Coding Style Writing Autoconf macros à la Autoconf
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Autoconf macros are defined using the AC_DEFUN
macro, which is
similar to the M4 builtin m4_define
macro. In addition to
defining a macro, AC_DEFUN
adds to it some code that is used to
constrain the order in which macros are called (see section 9.4.1 Prerequisite Macros).
An Autoconf macro definition looks like this:
AC_DEFUN(macro-name, macro-body) |
You can refer to any arguments passed to the macro as `$1', `$2', etc. See section `How to define new macros' in GNU m4, for more complete information on writing M4 macros.
Be sure to properly quote both the macro-body and the macro-name to avoid any problems if the macro happens to have been previously defined.
Each macro should have a header comment that gives its prototype, and a brief description. When arguments have default values, display them in the prototype. For example:
# AC_MSG_ERROR(ERROR, [EXIT-STATUS = 1]) # -------------------------------------- m4_define([AC_MSG_ERROR], [{ _AC_ECHO([configure: error: $1], 2); exit m4_default([$2], 1); }]) |
Comments about the macro should be left in the header comment. Most other comments will make their way into `configure', so just keep using `#' to introduce comments.
If you have some very special comments about pure M4 code, comments
that make no sense in `configure' and in the header comment, then
use the builtin dnl
: it causes M4 to discard the text
through the next newline.
Keep in mind that dnl
is rarely needed to introduce comments;
dnl
is more useful to get rid of the newlines following macros
that produce no output, such as AC_REQUIRE
.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
All of the Autoconf macros have all-uppercase names starting with `AC_' to prevent them from accidentally conflicting with other text. All shell variables that they use for internal purposes have mostly-lowercase names starting with `ac_'. To ensure that your macros don't conflict with present or future Autoconf macros, you should prefix your own macro names and any shell variables they use with some other sequence. Possibilities include your initials, or an abbreviation for the name of your organization or software package.
Most of the Autoconf macros' names follow a structured naming convention that indicates the kind of feature check by the name. The macro names consist of several words, separated by underscores, going from most general to most specific. The names of their cache variables use the same convention (see section 7.3.1 Cache Variable Names, for more information on them).
The first word of the name after `AC_' usually tells the category of the feature being tested. Here are the categories used in Autoconf for specific test macros, the kind of macro that you are more likely to write. They are also used for cache variables, in all-lowercase. Use them where applicable; where they're not, invent your own categories.
C
DECL
FUNC
GROUP
HEADER
LIB
PATH
PROG
MEMBER
SYS
TYPE
VAR
After the category comes the name of the particular feature being
tested. Any further words in the macro name indicate particular aspects
of the feature. For example, AC_FUNC_UTIME_NULL
checks the
behavior of the utime
function when called with a NULL
pointer.
An internal macro should have a name that starts with an underscore;
Autoconf internals should therefore start with `_AC_'.
Additionally, a macro that is an internal subroutine of another macro
should have a name that starts with an underscore and the name of that
other macro, followed by one or more words saying what the internal
macro does. For example, AC_PATH_X
has internal macros
_AC_PATH_X_XMKMF
and _AC_PATH_X_DIRECT
.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
When macros statically diagnose abnormal situations, benign or fatal,
they should report them using these macros. For dynamic issues, i.e.,
when configure
is run, see 7.4 Printing Messages.
autoconf
die.
When the user runs `autoconf -W error', warnings from
AC_DIAGNOSE
and AC_WARNING
are reported as error, see
3.4 Using autoconf
to Create configure
.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Some Autoconf macros depend on other macros having been called first in order to work correctly. Autoconf provides a way to ensure that certain macros are called if needed and a way to warn the user if macros are called in an order that might cause incorrect operation.
9.4.1 Prerequisite Macros Ensuring required information 9.4.2 Suggested Ordering Warning about possible ordering problems
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
A macro that you write might need to use values that have previously
been computed by other macros. For example, AC_DECL_YYTEXT
examines the output of flex
or lex
, so it depends on
AC_PROG_LEX
having been called first to set the shell variable
LEX
.
Rather than forcing the user of the macros to keep track of the
dependencies between them, you can use the AC_REQUIRE
macro to do
it automatically. AC_REQUIRE
can ensure that a macro is only
called if it is needed, and only called once.
AC_DEFUN
or else contain a call to AC_PROVIDE
to indicate
that it has been called.
AC_REQUIRE
must be used inside an AC_DEFUN
'd macro; it
must not be called from the top level.
AC_REQUIRE
is often misunderstood. It really implements
dependencies between macros in the sense that if one macro depends upon
another, the latter will be expanded before the body of the
former. In particular, `AC_REQUIRE(FOO)' is not replaced with the
body of FOO
. For instance, this definition of macros:
AC_DEFUN([TRAVOLTA], [test "$body_temperature_in_celsius" -gt "38" && dance_floor=occupied]) AC_DEFUN([NEWTON_JOHN], [test "$hair_style" = "curly" && dance_floor=occupied]) AC_DEFUN([RESERVE_DANCE_FLOOR], [if date | grep '^Sat.*pm' >/dev/null 2>&1; then AC_REQUIRE([TRAVOLTA]) AC_REQUIRE([NEWTON_JOHN]) fi]) |
with this `configure.ac'
AC_INIT RESERVE_DANCE_FLOOR if test "$dance_floor" = occupied; then AC_MSG_ERROR([cannot pick up here, let's move]) fi |
will not leave you with a better chance to meet a kindred soul at other times than Saturday night since it expands into:
test "$body_temperature_in_Celsius" -gt "38" && dance_floor=occupied test "$hair_style" = "curly" && dance_floor=occupied fi if date | grep '^Sat.*pm' >/dev/null 2>&1; then fi |
This behavior was chosen on purpose: (i) it prevents messages in required macros from interrupting the messages in the requiring macros; (ii) it avoids bad surprises when shell conditionals are used, as in:
if ...; then AC_REQUIRE([SOME_CHECK]) fi ... SOME_CHECK |
You are encouraged to put all AC_REQUIRE
s at the beginning of a
macro. You can use dnl
to avoid the empty lines they leave.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Some macros should be run before another macro if both are called, but neither requires that the other be called. For example, a macro that changes the behavior of the C compiler should be called before any macros that run the C compiler. Many of these dependencies are noted in the documentation.
Autoconf provides the AC_BEFORE
macro to warn users when macros
with this kind of dependency appear out of order in a
`configure.ac' file. The warning occurs when creating
configure
from `configure.ac', not when running
configure
.
For example, AC_PROG_CPP
checks whether the C compiler
can run the C preprocessor when given the `-E' option. It should
therefore be called after any macros that change which C compiler is
being used, such as AC_PROG_CC
. So AC_PROG_CC
contains:
AC_BEFORE([$0], [AC_PROG_CPP])dnl |
This warns the user if a call to AC_PROG_CPP
has already occurred
when AC_PROG_CC
is called.
AC_BEFORE
. The
macro called-macro-name must have been defined using
AC_DEFUN
or else contain a call to AC_PROVIDE
to indicate
that it has been called.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Configuration and portability technology has evolved over the years.
Often better ways of solving a particular problem are developed, or
ad-hoc approaches are systematized. This process has occurred in many
parts of Autoconf. One result is that some of the macros are now
considered obsolete; they still work, but are no longer considered
the best thing to do, hence they should be replaced with more modern
macros. Ideally, autoupdate
should replace the old macro calls
with their modern implementation.
Autoconf provides a simple means to obsolete a macro.
AC_DEFUN
is that the user will be warned that
old-macro is now obsolete.
If she then uses autoupdate
, the call to old-macro will be
replaced by the modern implementation. The additional
message is then printed.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
The Autoconf macros follow a strict coding style. You are encouraged to follow this style, especially if you intend to distribute your macro, either by contributing it to Autoconf itself, or via other means.
The first requirement is to pay great attention to the quotation. For more details, see 3.1.2 The Autoconf Language, and 8.1 M4 Quotation.
Do not try to invent new interfaces. It is likely that there is a macro in Autoconf that resembles the macro you are defining: try to stick to this existing interface (order of arguments, default values, etc.). We are conscious that some of these interfaces are not perfect; nevertheless, when harmless, homogeneity should be preferred over creativity.
Be careful about clashes both between M4 symbols and between shell variables.
If you stick to the suggested M4 naming scheme (see section 9.2 Macro Names),
you are unlikely to generate conflicts. Nevertheless, when you need to
set a special value, avoid using a regular macro name; rather,
use an "impossible" name. For instance, up to version 2.13, the macro
AC_SUBST
used to remember what symbols were already defined
by setting AC_SUBST_symbol
, which is a regular macro name.
But since there is a macro named AC_SUBST_FILE
, it was just
impossible to `AC_SUBST(FILE)'! In this case,
AC_SUBST(symbol)
or _AC_SUBST(symbol)
should
have been used (yes, with the parentheses)...or better yet, high-level
macros such as AC_EXPAND_ONCE
.
No Autoconf macro should ever enter the user-variable name space; i.e.,
except for the variables that are the actual result of running the
macro, all shell variables should start with ac_
. In
addition, small macros or any macro that is likely to be embedded in
other macros should be careful not to use obvious names.
Do not use dnl
to introduce comments: most of the comments you
are likely to write are either header comments which are not output
anyway, or comments that should make their way into `configure'.
There are exceptional cases where you do want to comment special M4
constructs, in which case dnl
is right, but keep in mind that it
is unlikely.
M4 ignores the leading spaces before each argument, use this feature to indent in such a way that arguments are (more or less) aligned with the opening parenthesis of the macro being called. For instance, instead of
AC_CACHE_CHECK(for EMX OS/2 environment, ac_cv_emxos2, [AC_COMPILE_IFELSE([AC_LANG_PROGRAM(, [return __EMX__;])], [ac_cv_emxos2=yes], [ac_cv_emxos2=no])]) |
write
AC_CACHE_CHECK([for EMX OS/2 environment], [ac_cv_emxos2], [AC_COMPILE_IFELSE([AC_LANG_PROGRAM([], [return __EMX__;])], [ac_cv_emxos2=yes], [ac_cv_emxos2=no])]) |
or even
AC_CACHE_CHECK([for EMX OS/2 environment], [ac_cv_emxos2], [AC_COMPILE_IFELSE([AC_LANG_PROGRAM([], [return __EMX__;])], [ac_cv_emxos2=yes], [ac_cv_emxos2=no])]) |
When using AC_RUN_IFELSE
or any macro that cannot work when
cross-compiling, provide a pessimistic value (typically `no').
Feel free to use various tricks to prevent auxiliary tools, such as syntax-highlighting editors, from behaving improperly. For instance, instead of:
m4_bpatsubst([$1], [$"]) |
use
m4_bpatsubst([$1], [$""]) |
so that Emacsen do not open an endless "string" at the first quote. For the same reasons, avoid:
test $[#] != 0 |
and use:
test $[@%:@] != 0 |
Otherwise, the closing bracket would be hidden inside a `#'-comment,
breaking the bracket-matching highlighting from Emacsen. Note the
preferred style to escape from M4: `$[1]', `$[@]', etc. Do
not escape when it is unnecessary. Common examples of useless quotation
are `[$]$1' (write `$$1'), `[$]var' (use `$var'),
etc. If you add portability issues to the picture, you'll prefer
`${1+"$[@]"}' to `"[$]@"', and you'll prefer do something
better than hacking Autoconf :-)
.
When using sed
, don't use `-e' except for indenting
purpose. With the s
command, the preferred separator is `/'
unless `/' itself is used in the command, in which case you should
use `,'.
See section 9.1 Macro Definitions, for details on how to define a macro. If a
macro doesn't use AC_REQUIRE
and it is expected to never be the
object of an AC_REQUIRE
directive, then use m4_define
. In
case of doubt, use AC_DEFUN
. All the AC_REQUIRE
statements should be at the beginning of the macro, dnl
'ed.
You should not rely on the number of arguments: instead of checking whether an argument is missing, test that it is not empty. It provides both a simpler and a more predictable interface to the user, and saves room for further arguments.
Unless the macro is short, try to leave the closing `])' at the
beginning of a line, followed by a comment that repeats the name of the
macro being defined. This introduces an additional newline in
configure
; normally, that is not a problem, but if you want to
remove it you can use `[]dnl' on the last line. You can similarly
use `[]dnl' after a macro call to remove its newline. `[]dnl'
is recommended instead of `dnl' to ensure that M4 does not
interpret the `dnl' as being attached to the preceding text or
macro output. For example, instead of:
AC_DEFUN([AC_PATH_X], [AC_MSG_CHECKING([for X]) AC_REQUIRE_CPP() # ...omitted... AC_MSG_RESULT([libraries $x_libraries, headers $x_includes]) fi]) |
you would write:
AC_DEFUN([AC_PATH_X], [AC_REQUIRE_CPP()[]dnl AC_MSG_CHECKING([for X]) # ...omitted... AC_MSG_RESULT([libraries $x_libraries, headers $x_includes]) fi[]dnl ])# AC_PATH_X |
If the macro is long, try to split it into logical chunks. Typically,
macros that check for a bug in a function and prepare its
AC_LIBOBJ
replacement should have an auxiliary macro to perform
this setup. Do not hesitate to introduce auxiliary macros to factor
your code.
In order to highlight the recommended coding style, here is a macro written the old way:
dnl Check for EMX on OS/2. dnl _AC_EMXOS2 AC_DEFUN(_AC_EMXOS2, [AC_CACHE_CHECK(for EMX OS/2 environment, ac_cv_emxos2, [AC_COMPILE_IFELSE([AC_LANG_PROGRAM(, return __EMX__;)], ac_cv_emxos2=yes, ac_cv_emxos2=no)]) test "$ac_cv_emxos2" = yes && EMXOS2=yes]) |
and the new way:
# _AC_EMXOS2 # ---------- # Check for EMX on OS/2. m4_define([_AC_EMXOS2], [AC_CACHE_CHECK([for EMX OS/2 environment], [ac_cv_emxos2], [AC_COMPILE_IFELSE([AC_LANG_PROGRAM([], [return __EMX__;])], [ac_cv_emxos2=yes], [ac_cv_emxos2=no])]) test "$ac_cv_emxos2" = yes && EMXOS2=yes[]dnl ])# _AC_EMXOS2 |
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
When writing your own checks, there are some shell-script programming techniques you should avoid in order to make your code portable. The Bourne shell and upward-compatible shells like the Korn shell and Bash have evolved over the years, but to prevent trouble, do not take advantage of features that were added after UNIX version 7, circa 1977 (see section 6.7 Systemology).
You should not use shell functions, aliases, negated character
classes, or other features that are not found in all Bourne-compatible
shells; restrict yourself to the lowest common denominator. Even
unset
is not supported by all shells! Also, include a space
after the exclamation point in interpreter specifications, like this:
#! /usr/bin/perl |
If you omit the space before the path, then 4.2BSD based systems (such as DYNIX) will ignore the line, because they interpret `#! /' as a 4-byte magic number. Some old systems have quite small limits on the length of the `#!' line too, for instance 32 bytes (not including the newline) on SunOS 4.
The set of external programs you should run in a configure
script
is fairly small. See section `Utilities in Makefiles' in GNU Coding Standards, for the list. This
restriction allows users to start out with a fairly small set of
programs and build the rest, avoiding too many interdependencies between
packages.
Some of these external utilities have a portable subset of features; see 10.9 Limitations of Usual Tools.
There are other sources of documentation about shells. See for instance the Shell FAQs.
10.1 Shellology A zoology of shells 10.2 Here-Documents Quirks and tricks 10.3 File Descriptors FDs and redirections 10.4 File System Conventions File- and pathnames 10.5 Shell Substitutions Variable and command expansions 10.6 Assignments Varying side effects of assignments 10.7 Special Shell Variables Variables you should not change 10.8 Limitations of Shell Builtins Portable use of not so portable /bin/sh 10.9 Limitations of Usual Tools Portable use of portable tools 10.10 Limitations of Make Portable Makefiles
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
There are several families of shells, most prominently the Bourne family and the C shell family which are deeply incompatible. If you want to write portable shell scripts, avoid members of the C shell family. The the Shell difference FAQ includes a small history of Unix shells, and a comparison between several of them.
Below we describe some of the members of the Bourne shell family.
ash
is often used on GNU/Linux and BSD
systems as a light-weight Bourne-compatible shell. Ash 0.2 has some
bugs that are fixed in the 0.3.x series, but portable shell scripts
should work around them, since version 0.2 is still shipped with many
GNU/Linux distributions.
To be compatible with Ash 0.2:
foo= false $foo echo "Don't use it: $?" |
cat ${FOO=`bar`} |
bash
, test if
BASH_VERSION
is set. To disable its extensions and require
POSIX compatibility, run `set -o posix'. See section `Bash POSIX Mode' in The GNU Bash Reference Manual, for details.
bash
use a different format for the
output of the set
builtin, designed to make evaluating its
output easier. However, this output is not compatible with earlier
versions of bash
(or with many other shells, probably). So if
you use bash
2.05 or higher to execute configure
,
you'll need to use bash
2.05 for all other build tasks as well.
/usr/xpg4/bin/sh
on Solaris
/usr/xpg4/bin/sh
and is part of an extra optional package.
There is no extra charge for this package, but it is also not part of a
minimal OS install and therefore some folks may not have it.
zsh
, test if
ZSH_VERSION
is set. By default zsh
is not
compatible with the Bourne shell: you have to run `emulate sh' and
set NULLCMD
to `:'. See section `Compatibility' in The Z Shell Manual, for details.
Zsh 3.0.8 is the native /bin/sh
on Mac OS X 10.0.3.
The following discussion between Russ Allbery and Robert Lipe is worth reading:
Russ Allbery:
The GNU assumption that/bin/sh
is the one and only shell leads to a permanent deadlock. Vendors don't want to break users' existing shell scripts, and there are some corner cases in the Bourne shell that are not completely compatible with a POSIX shell. Thus, vendors who have taken this route will never (OK..."never say never") replace the Bourne shell (as/bin/sh
) with a POSIX shell.
Robert Lipe:
This is exactly the problem. While most (at least most System V's) do have a Bourne shell that accepts shell functions most vendor/bin/sh
programs are not the POSIX shell.So while most modern systems do have a shell somewhere that meets the POSIX standard, the challenge is to find it.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Don't rely on `\' being preserved just because it has no special
meaning together with the next symbol. In the native /bin/sh
on OpenBSD 2.7 `\"' expands to `"' in here-documents with
unquoted delimiter. As a general rule, if `\\' expands to `\'
use `\\' to get `\'.
With OpenBSD 2.7's /bin/sh
$ cat <<EOF > \" \\ > EOF " \ |
and with Bash:
bash-2.04$ cat <<EOF > \" \\ > EOF \" \ |
Many older shells (including the Bourne shell) implement here-documents
inefficiently. And some shells mishandle large here-documents: for
example, Solaris 8 dtksh
, which is derived from
ksh
M-12/28/93d, mishandles variable expansion that occurs
on 1024-byte buffer boundaries within a here-document. Users can
generally fix these problems by using a faster or more reliable
shell, e.g., by using the command `bash ./configure' rather than
plain `./configure'.
Some shells can be extremely inefficient when there are a lot of here-documents inside a single statement. For instance if your `configure.ac' includes something like:
if <cross_compiling>; then assume this and that else check this check that check something else ... on and on forever ... fi |
A shell parses the whole if
/fi
construct, creating
temporary files for each here document in it. Some shells create links
for such here-documents on every fork
, so that the clean-up code
they had installed correctly removes them. It is creating the links
that can take the shell forever.
Moving the tests out of the if
/fi
, or creating multiple
if
/fi
constructs, would improve the performance
significantly. Anyway, this kind of construct is not exactly the
typical use of Autoconf. In fact, it's even not recommended, because M4
macros can't look into shell conditionals, so we may fail to expand a
macro when it was expanded before in a conditional path, and the
condition turned out to be false at run-time, and we end up not
executing the macro at all.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Some file descriptors shall not be used, since some systems, admittedly arcane, use them for special purpose:
3 --- some systems may open it to `/dev/tty'. 4 --- used on the Kubota Titan. |
Don't redirect the same file descriptor several times, as you are doomed to failure under Ultrix.
ULTRIX V4.4 (Rev. 69) System #31: Thu Aug 10 19:42:23 GMT 1995 UWS V4.4 (Rev. 11) $ eval 'echo matter >fullness' >void illegal io $ eval '(echo matter >fullness)' >void illegal io $ (eval '(echo matter >fullness)') >void Ambiguous output redirect. |
In each case the expected result is of course `fullness' containing `matter' and `void' being empty.
Don't try to redirect the standard error of a command substitution: it must be done inside the command substitution: when running `: `cd /zorglub` 2>/dev/null' expect the error message to escape, while `: `cd /zorglub 2>/dev/null`' works properly.
It is worth noting that Zsh (but not Ash nor Bash) makes it possible in assignments though: `foo=`cd /zorglub` 2>/dev/null'.
Most shells, if not all (including Bash, Zsh, Ash), output traces on stderr, even for sub-shells. This might result in undesirable content if you meant to capture the standard-error output of the inner command:
$ ash -x -c '(eval "echo foo >&2") 2>stderr' $ cat stderr + eval echo foo >&2 + echo foo foo $ bash -x -c '(eval "echo foo >&2") 2>stderr' $ cat stderr + eval 'echo foo >&2' ++ echo foo foo $ zsh -x -c '(eval "echo foo >&2") 2>stderr' # Traces on startup files deleted here. $ cat stderr +zsh:1> eval echo foo >&2 +zsh:1> echo foo foo |
You'll appreciate the various levels of detail....
One workaround is to grep out uninteresting lines, hoping not to remove good ones....
Don't try to move/delete open files, such as in `exec >foo; mv foo
bar'; see 10.8 Limitations of Shell Builtins, mv
for more details.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
While autoconf
and friends will usually be run on some Unix
variety, it can and will be used on other systems, most notably DOS
variants. This impacts several assumptions regarding file and
path names.
For example, the following code:
case $foo_dir in /*) # Absolute ;; *) foo_dir=$dots$foo_dir ;; esac |
will fail to properly detect absolute paths on those systems, because they can use a drivespec, and will usually use a backslash as directory separator. The canonical way to check for absolute paths is:
case $foo_dir in [\\/]* | ?:[\\/]* ) # Absolute ;; *) foo_dir=$dots$foo_dir ;; esac |
Make sure you quote the brackets if appropriate and keep the backslash as first character (see section 10.8 Limitations of Shell Builtins).
Also, because the colon is used as part of a drivespec, these systems don't
use it as path separator. When creating or accessing paths, use the
PATH_SEPARATOR
output variable instead. configure
sets this
to the appropriate value (`:' or `;') when it starts up.
File names need extra care as well. While DOS-based environments
that are Unixy enough to run autoconf
(such as DJGPP) will
usually be able to handle long file names properly, there are still
limitations that can seriously break packages. Several of these issues
can be easily detected by the
doschk
package.
A short overview follows; problems are marked with SFN/LFN to indicate where they apply: SFN means the issues are only relevant to plain DOS, not to DOS boxes under Windows, while LFN identifies problems that exist even under Windows.
autoconf
uses a .in suffix for template files.
This is perfectly OK on Unices:
AC_CONFIG_HEADERS([config.h]) AC_CONFIG_FILES([source.c foo.bar]) AC_OUTPUT |
but it causes problems on DOS, as it requires `config.h.in', `source.c.in' and `foo.bar.in'. To make your package more portable to DOS-based environments, you should use this instead:
AC_CONFIG_HEADERS([config.h:config.hin]) AC_CONFIG_FILES([source.c:source.cin foo.bar:foobar.in]) AC_OUTPUT |
autoconf
.
make
; if there's a file called `INSTALL' in
the directory, `make install' will do nothing (unless the
`install' target is marked as PHONY).
Note: This is not usually a problem under Windows, as it uses numeric tails in the short version of filenames to make them unique. However, a registry setting can turn this behavior off. While this makes it possible to share file trees containing long file names between SFN and LFN environments, it also means the above problem applies there as well.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Contrary to a persistent urban legend, the Bourne shell does not
systematically split variables and back-quoted expressions, in particular
on the right-hand side of assignments and in the argument of case
.
For instance, the following code:
case "$given_srcdir" in .) top_srcdir="`echo "$dots" | sed 's,/$,,'`" *) top_srcdir="$dots$given_srcdir" ;; esac |
is more readable when written as:
case $given_srcdir in .) top_srcdir=`echo "$dots" | sed 's,/$,,'` *) top_srcdir=$dots$given_srcdir ;; esac |
and in fact it is even more portable: in the first case of the
first attempt, the computation of top_srcdir
is not portable,
since not all shells properly understand "`..."..."...`"
.
Worse yet, not all shells understand "`...\"...\"...`"
the same way. There is just no portable way to use double-quoted
strings inside double-quoted back-quoted expressions (pfew!).
$@
The traditional way to work around this portability problem is to use `${1+"$@"}'. Unfortunately this method does not work with Zsh (3.x and 4.x), which is used on Mac OS X. When emulating the Bourne shell, Zsh performs word splitting on `${1+"$@"}':
zsh $ emulate sh zsh $ for i in "$@"; do echo $i; done Hello World ! zsh $ for i in ${1+"$@"}; do echo $i; done Hello World ! |
Zsh handles plain `"$@"' properly, but we can't use plain `"$@"' because of the portability problems mentioned above. One workaround relies on Zsh's "global aliases" to convert `${1+"$@"}' into `"$@"' by itself:
test "${ZSH_VERSION+set}" = set && alias -g '${1+"$@"}'='"$@"' |
A more conservative workaround is to avoid `"$@"' if it is possible that there may be no positional arguments. For example, instead of:
cat conftest.c "$@" |
you can use this instead:
case $# in 0) cat conftest.c;; *) cat conftest.c "$@";; esac |
${var:-value}
sh
, don't accept the
colon for any shell substitution, and complain and die.
${var=literal}
: ${var='Some words'} |
otherwise some shells, such as on Digital Unix V 5.0, will die because of a "bad substitution".
Solaris' /bin/sh
has a frightening bug in its interpretation
of this. Imagine you need set a variable to a string containing
`}'. This `}' character confuses Solaris' /bin/sh
when the affected variable was already set. This bug can be exercised
by running:
$ unset foo $ foo=${foo='}'} $ echo $foo } $ foo=${foo='}' # no error; this hints to what the bug is $ echo $foo } $ foo=${foo='}'} $ echo $foo }} ^ ugh! |
It seems that `}' is interpreted as matching `${', even though it is enclosed in single quotes. The problem doesn't happen using double quotes.
${var=expanded-value}
default="yu,yaa" : ${var="$default"} |
will set var to `M-yM-uM-,M-yM-aM-a', i.e., the 8th bit of each char will be set. You won't observe the phenomenon using a simple `echo $var' since apparently the shell resets the 8th bit when it expands $var. Here are two means to make this shell confess its sins:
$ cat -v <<EOF $var EOF |
and
$ set | grep '^var=' | cat -v |
One classic incarnation of this bug is:
default="a b c" : ${list="$default"} for c in $list; do echo $c done |
You'll get `a b c' on a single line. Why? Because there are no spaces in `$list': there are `M- ', i.e., spaces with the 8th bit set, hence no IFS splitting is performed!!!
One piece of good news is that Ultrix works fine with `: ${list=$default}'; i.e., if you don't quote. The bad news is then that QNX 4.25 then sets list to the last item of default!
The portable way out consists in using a double assignment, to switch the 8th bit twice on Ultrix:
list=${list="$default"} |
...but beware of the `}' bug from Solaris (see above). For safety, use:
test "${var+set}" = set || var={value} |
`commands`
For instance, if you wanted to check that cd
is silent, do not
use `test -z "`cd /`"' because the following can happen:
$ pwd /tmp $ test -n "`cd /`" && pwd / |
The result of `foo=`exit 1`' is left as an exercise to the reader.
$(commands)
$ showrev -c /bin/sh | grep version Command version: SunOS 5.8 Generic 109324-02 February 2001 $ echo $(echo blah) syntax error: `(' unexpected |
nor does IRIX 6.5's Bourne shell:
$ uname -a IRIX firebird-image 6.5 07151432 IP22 $ echo $(echo blah) $(echo blah) |
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
When setting several variables in a row, be aware that the order of the evaluation is undefined. For instance `foo=1 foo=2; echo $foo' gives `1' with sh on Solaris, but `2' with Bash. You must use `;' to enforce the order: `foo=1; foo=2; echo $foo'.
Don't rely on the following to find `subdir/program':
PATH=subdir$PATH_SEPARATOR$PATH program |
as this does not work with Zsh 3.0.6. Use something like this instead:
(PATH=subdir$PATH_SEPARATOR$PATH; export PATH; exec program) |
Don't rely on the exit status of an assignment: Ash 0.2 does not change the status and propagates that of the last statement:
$ false || foo=bar; echo $? 1 $ false || foo=`:`; echo $? 0 |
and to make things even worse, QNX 4.25 just sets the exit status to 0 in any case:
$ foo=`exit 1`; echo $? 0 |
To assign default values, follow this algorithm:
: ${var='my literal'} |
: ${var="$default"} |
var=${var="$default"} |
test "${var+set}" = set || var='${indirection}' |
In most cases `var=${var="$default"}' is fine, but in case of doubt, just use the latter. See section 10.5 Shell Substitutions, items `${var:-value}' and `${var=value}' for the rationale.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Some shell variables should not be used, since they can have a deep
influence on the behavior of the shell. In order to recover a sane
behavior from the shell, some variables should be unset, but
unset
is not portable (see section 10.8 Limitations of Shell Builtins) and a
fallback value is needed. We list these values below.
CDPATH
cd
with a relative filename. POSIX
1003.1-2001 says that if a nonempty directory name from CDPATH
is used successfully, cd
prints the resulting absolute
filename. Unfortunately this output can break idioms like
`abs=`cd src && pwd`' because abs
receives the path twice.
Also, many shells do not conform to this part of POSIX; for
example, zsh
prints the result only if a directory name
other than `.' was chosen from CDPATH
.
In practice the shells that have this problem also support
unset
, so you can work around the problem as follows:
(unset CDPATH) >/dev/null 2>&1 && unset CDPATH |
Autoconf-generated scripts automatically unset CDPATH
if
possible, so you need not worry about this problem in those scripts.
IFS
IFS
to backslash. Indeed,
Bourne shells use the first character (backslash) when joining the
components in `"$@"' and some shells then re-interpret (!) the
backslash escapes, so you can end up with backspace and other strange
characters.
The proper value for IFS
(in regular code, not when performing
splits) is `SPCTABRET'. The first character is
especially important, as it is used to join the arguments in `@*'.
LANG
LC_ALL
LC_COLLATE
LC_CTYPE
LC_MESSAGES
LC_MONETARY
LC_NUMERIC
LC_TIME
Autoconf-generated scripts normally set all these variables to `C' because so much configuration code assumes the C locale and POSIX requires that locale environment variables be set to `C' if the C locale is desired. However, some older, nonstandard systems (notably SCO) break if locale environment variables are set to `C', so when running on these systems Autoconf-generated scripts unset the variables instead.
LANGUAGE
LANGUAGE
is not specified by POSIX, but it is a GNU
extension that overrides LC_ALL
in some cases, so
Autoconf-generated scripts set it too.
LC_ADDRESS
LC_IDENTIFICATION
LC_MEASUREMENT
LC_NAME
LC_PAPER
LC_TELEPHONE
These locale environment variables are GNU extensions. They
are treated like their POSIX brethren (LC_COLLATE
,
etc.) as described above.
LINENO
LINENO
.
Its value is the line number of the beginning of the current command.
Autoconf attempts to execute configure
with a modern shell.
If no such shell is available, it attempts to implement LINENO
with a Sed prepass that replaces each instance of the string
$LINENO
(not followed by an alphanumeric character) with the
line's number.
You should not rely on LINENO
within eval
, as the
behavior differs in practice. Also, the possibility of the Sed
prepass means that you should not rely on $LINENO
when quoted,
when in here-documents, or when in long commands that cross line
boundaries. Subshells should be OK, though. In the following
example, lines 1, 6, and 9 are portable, but the other instances of
LINENO
are not:
$ cat lineno echo 1. $LINENO cat <<EOF 3. $LINENO 4. $LINENO EOF ( echo 6. $LINENO ) eval 'echo 7. $LINENO' echo 8. '$LINENO' echo 9. $LINENO ' 10.' $LINENO $ bash-2.05 lineno 1. 1 3. 2 4. 2 6. 6 7. 1 8. $LINENO 9. 9 10. 9 $ zsh-3.0.6 lineno 1. 1 3. 2 4. 2 6. 6 7. 7 8. $LINENO 9. 9 10. 9 $ pdksh-5.2.14 lineno 1. 1 3. 2 4. 2 6. 6 7. 0 8. $LINENO 9. 9 10. 9 $ sed '=' <lineno | > sed ' > N > s,$,-, > : loop > s,^\([0-9]*\)\(.*\)[$]LINENO\([^a-zA-Z0-9_]\),\1\2\1\3, > t loop > s,-$,, > s,^[0-9]*\n,, > ' | > sh 1. 1 3. 3 4. 4 6. 6 7. 7 8. 8 9. 9 10. 10 |
NULLCMD
zsh
executes
`$NULLCMD >foo'. The Bourne shell considers NULLCMD
to be
`:', while zsh
, even in Bourne shell compatibility mode,
sets NULLCMD
to `cat'. If you forgot to set NULLCMD
,
your script might be suspended waiting for data on its standard input.
ENV
MAIL
MAILPATH
PS1
PS2
PS4
ksh
) gets confused about
whether it is interactive, which means that (for example) a PS1
with a side effect can unexpectedly modify `$?'. To work around
this bug, Autoconf-generated scripts do something like this:
(unset ENV) >/dev/null 2>&1 && unset ENV MAIL MAILPATH PS1='$ ' PS2='> ' PS4='+ ' |
PWD
cd
and
pwd
must update the PWD
environment variable to point
to the logical path to the current directory, but traditional shells
do not support this. This can cause confusion if one shell instance
maintains PWD
but a subsidiary and different shell does not know
about PWD
and executes cd
; in this case PWD
will
point to the wrong directory. Use ``pwd`' rather than
`$PWD'.
status
zsh
(at least 3.1.6),
hence read-only. Do not use it.
PATH_SEPARATOR
configure
will detect the appropriate path
separator for the build system and set the PATH_SEPARATOR
output
variable accordingly.
On DJGPP systems, the PATH_SEPARATOR
environment variable can be
set to either `:' or `;' to control the path separator
bash
uses to set up certain environment variables (such as
PATH
). Since this only works inside bash
, you want
configure
to detect the regular DOS path separator
(`;'), so it can be safely substituted in files that may not support
`;' as path separator. So it is recommended to either unset this
variable or set it to `;'.
RANDOM
RANDOM
, a variable that returns a different
integer each time it is used. Most of the time, its value does not
change when it is not used, but on IRIX 6.5 the value changes all
the time. This can be observed by using set
.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
No, no, we are serious: some shells do have limitations! :)
You should always keep in mind that any builtin or command may support
options, and therefore have a very different behavior with arguments
starting with a dash. For instance, the innocent `echo "$word"'
can give unexpected results when word
starts with a dash. It is
often possible to avoid this problem using `echo "x$word"', taking
the `x' into account later in the pipe.
.
.
only with regular files (use `test -f'). Bash
2.03, for instance, chokes on `. /dev/null'. Also, remember that
.
uses PATH
if its argument contains no slashes, so if
you want to use .
on a file `foo' in the current
directory, you must use `. ./foo'.
!
!
; you'll have to rewrite your code.
break
cd
cd
must support
the `-L' ("logical") and `-P' ("physical") options,
with `-L' being the default. However, traditional shells do
not support these options, and their cd
command has the
`-P' behavior.
Portable scripts should assume neither option is supported, and should
assume neither behavior is the default. This can be a bit tricky,
since the POSIX default behavior means that, for example,
`ls ..' and `cd ..' may refer to different directories if
the current logical directory is a symbolic link. It is safe to use
cd dir
if dir contains no `..' components.
Also, Autoconf-generated scripts check for this problem when computing
variables like ac_top_srcdir
(see section 4.5 Performing Configuration Actions),
so it is safe to cd
to these variables.
Also please see the discussion of the pwd
command.
case
You don't need the final `;;', but you should use it.
Because of a bug in its fnmatch
, bash
fails to properly
handle backslashes in character classes:
bash-2.02$ case /tmp in [/\\]*) echo OK;; esac bash-2.02$ |
This is extremely unfortunate, since you are likely to use this code to handle UNIX or MS-DOS absolute paths. To work around this bug, always put the backslash first:
bash-2.02$ case '\TMP' in [\\/]*) echo OK;; esac OK bash-2.02$ case /tmp in [\\/]*) echo OK;; esac OK |
Some shells, such as Ash 0.3.8, are confused by an empty
case
/esac
:
ash-0.3.8 $ case foo in esac; error-->Syntax error: ";" unexpected (expecting ")") |
Many shells still do not support parenthesized cases, which is a pity for those of us using tools that rely on balanced parentheses. For instance, Solaris 2.8's Bourne shell:
$ case foo in (foo) echo foo;; esac error-->syntax error: `(' unexpected |
echo
echo
is probably the most surprising source of
portability troubles. It is not possible to use `echo' portably
unless both options and escape sequences are omitted. New applications
which are not aiming at portability should use `printf' instead of
`echo'.
Don't expect any option. See section 4.7.1 Preset Output Variables, ECHO_N
etc. for a means to simulate `-n'.
Do not use backslashes in the arguments, as there is no consensus on
their handling. On `echo '\n' | wc -l', the sh
of
Digital Unix 4.0 and MIPS RISC/OS 4.52, answer 2, but the Solaris'
sh
, Bash, and Zsh (in sh
emulation mode) report 1.
Please note that the problem is truly echo
: all the shells
understand `'\n'' as the string composed of a backslash and an
`n'.
Because of these problems, do not pass a string containing arbitrary
characters to echo
. For example, `echo "$foo"' is safe
if you know that foo's value cannot contain backslashes and cannot
start with `-', but otherwise you should use a here-document like
this:
cat <<EOF $foo EOF |
exit
exit
is supposed to be $?
;
unfortunately, some shells, such as the DJGPP port of Bash 2.04, just
perform `exit 0'.
bash-2.04$ foo=`exit 1` || echo fail fail bash-2.04$ foo=`(exit 1)` || echo fail fail bash-2.04$ foo=`(exit 1); exit` || echo fail bash-2.04$ |
Using `exit $?' restores the expected behavior.
Some shell scripts, such as those generated by autoconf
, use a
trap to clean up before exiting. If the last shell command exited with
nonzero status, the trap also exits with nonzero status so that the
invoker can tell that an error occurred.
Unfortunately, in some shells, such as Solaris 8 sh
, an exit
trap ignores the exit
command's argument. In these shells, a trap
cannot determine whether it was invoked by plain exit
or by
exit 1
. Instead of calling exit
directly, use the
AC_MSG_ERROR
macro that has a workaround for this problem.
export
export
dubs a shell variable environment
variable. Each update of exported variables corresponds to an update
of the environment variables. Conversely, each environment variable
received by the shell when it is launched should be imported as a shell
variable marked as exported.
Alas, many shells, such as Solaris 2.5, IRIX 6.3, IRIX 5.2,
AIX 4.1.5, and Digital UNIX 4.0, forget to
export
the environment variables they receive. As a result,
two variables coexist: the environment variable and the shell
variable. The following code demonstrates this failure:
#! /bin/sh echo $FOO FOO=bar echo $FOO exec /bin/sh $0 |
when run with `FOO=foo' in the environment, these shells will print alternately `foo' and `bar', although it should only print `foo' and then a sequence of `bar's.
Therefore you should export
again each environment variable
that you update.
false
false
to exit with status 1: in the native Bourne
shell of Solaris 8 it exits with status 255.
for
for arg do echo "$arg" done |
You may not leave the do
on the same line as for
,
since some shells improperly grok:
for arg; do echo "$arg" done |
If you want to explicitly refer to the positional arguments, given the `$@' bug (see section 10.5 Shell Substitutions), use:
for arg in ${1+"$@"}; do echo "$arg" done |
But keep in mind that Zsh, even in Bourne shell emulation mode, performs word splitting on `${1+"$@"}'; see 10.5 Shell Substitutions, item `$@', for more.
if
if ! cmp -s file file.new; then mv file.new file fi |
use:
if cmp -s file file.new; then :; else mv file.new file fi |
There are shells that do not reset the exit status from an if
:
$ if (exit 42); then true; fi; echo $? 42 |
whereas a proper shell should have printed `0'. This is especially bad in Makefiles since it produces false failures. This is why properly written Makefiles, such as Automake's, have such hairy constructs:
if test -f "$file"; then install "$file" "$dest" else : fi |
pwd
pwd
outputs a "logical"
directory name, some of whose components may be symbolic links. These
directory names are in contrast to "physical" directory names, whose
components are all directories.
POSIX 1003.1-2001 requires that pwd
must support
the `-L' ("logical") and `-P' ("physical") options,
with `-L' being the default. However, traditional shells do
not support these options, and their pwd
command has the
`-P' behavior.
Portable scripts should assume neither option is supported, and should assume neither behavior is the default. Also, on many hosts `/bin/pwd' is equivalent to `pwd -P', but POSIX does not require this behavior and portable scripts should not rely on it.
Typically it's best to use plain pwd
. On modern hosts this
outputs logical directory names, which have the following advantages:
pwd
cannot fail for this
reason.
Also please see the discussion of the cd
command.
set
shift
to pop it out:
set x $my_list; shift |
Some shells have the "opposite" problem of not recognizing all options (e.g., `set -e -x' assigns `-x' to the command line). It is better to elide these:
set -ex |
shift
shift
ing a bad idea when there is nothing left to
shift, but in addition it is not portable: the shell of MIPS
RISC/OS 4.52 refuses to do it.
source
.
instead.
test
test
program is the way to perform many file and string
tests. It is often invoked by the alternate name `[', but using
that name in Autoconf code is asking for trouble since it is an M4 quote
character.
If you need to make multiple checks using test
, combine them with
the shell operators `&&' and `||' instead of using the
test
operators `-a' and `-o'. On System V, the
precedence of `-a' and `-o' is wrong relative to the unary
operators; consequently, POSIX does not specify them, so using them
is nonportable. If you combine `&&' and `||' in the same
statement, keep in mind that they have equal precedence.
You may use `!' with test
, but not with if
:
`test ! -r foo || exit 1'.
test
(files)
configure
scripts to support cross-compilation, they
shouldn't do anything that tests features of the build system instead of
the host system. But occasionally you may find it necessary to check
whether some arbitrary file exists. To do so, use `test -f' or
`test -r'. Do not use `test -x', because 4.3BSD does not
have it. Do not use `test -e' either, because Solaris 2.5 does not
have it.
test
(strings)
test
might interpret its argument as an
option (e.g., `string = "-n"').
Contrary to a common belief, `test -n string' and `test -z string' are portable. Nevertheless many shells (such as Solaris 2.5, AIX 3.2, UNICOS 10.0.0.6, Digital Unix 4 etc.) have bizarre precedence and may be confused if string looks like an operator:
$ test -n = test: argument expected |
If there are risks, use `test "xstring" = x' or `test "xstring" != x' instead.
It is common to find variations of the following idiom:
test -n "`echo $ac_feature | sed 's/[-a-zA-Z0-9_]//g'`" && action |
to take an action when a token matches a given pattern. Such constructs should always be avoided by using:
echo "$ac_feature" | grep '[^-a-zA-Z0-9_]' >/dev/null 2>&1 && action |
Use case
where possible since it is faster, being a shell builtin:
case $ac_feature in *[!-a-zA-Z0-9_]*) action;; esac |
Alas, negated character classes are probably not portable, although no
shell is known to not support the POSIX syntax `[!...]'
(when in interactive mode, zsh
is confused by the
`[!...]' syntax and looks for an event in its history because of
`!'). Many shells do not support the alternative syntax
`[^...]' (Solaris, Digital Unix, etc.).
One solution can be:
expr "$ac_feature" : '.*[^-a-zA-Z0-9_]' >/dev/null && action |
or better yet
expr "x$ac_feature" : '.*[^-a-zA-Z0-9_]' >/dev/null && action |
`expr "Xfoo" : "Xbar"' is more robust than `echo "Xfoo" | grep "^Xbar"', because it avoids problems when `foo' contains backslashes.
trap
trap
run when the script ends (either via an
explicit exit
, or the end of the script).
Although POSIX is not absolutely clear on this point, it is widely
admitted that when entering the trap `$?' should be set to the exit
status of the last command run before the trap. The ambiguity can be
summarized as: "when the trap is launched by an exit
, what is
the last command run: that before exit
, or
exit
itself?"
Bash considers exit
to be the last command, while Zsh and
Solaris 8 sh
consider that when the trap is run it is
still in the exit
, hence it is the previous exit status
that the trap receives:
$ cat trap.sh trap 'echo $?' 0 (exit 42); exit 0 $ zsh trap.sh 42 $ bash trap.sh 0 |
The portable solution is then simple: when you want to `exit 42',
run `(exit 42); exit 42', the first exit
being used to
set the exit status to 42 for Zsh, and the second to trigger the trap
and pass 42 as exit status for Bash.
The shell in FreeBSD 4.0 has the following bug: `$?' is
reset to 0 by empty lines if the code is inside trap
.
$ trap 'false echo $?' 0 $ exit 0 |
Fortunately, this bug only affects trap
.
true
true
is portable.
Nevertheless, it's not always a builtin (e.g., Bash 1.x), and the
portable shell community tends to prefer using :
. This has a
funny side effect: when asked whether false
is more portable
than true
Alexandre Oliva answered:
In a sense, yes, because if it doesn't exist, the shell will produce an exit status of failure, which is correct forfalse
, but not fortrue
.
unset
unset
. Nevertheless, because
it is extremely useful to disable embarrassing variables such as
PS1
, you can test for its existence and use
it provided you give a neutralizing value when unset
is
not supported:
if (unset FOO) >/dev/null 2>&1; then unset=unset else unset=false fi $unset PS1 || PS1='$ ' |
See section 10.7 Special Shell Variables, for some neutralizing values. Also, see
10.8 Limitations of Shell Builtins, documentation of export
, for
the case of environment variables.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
The small set of tools you can expect to find on any machine can still include some limitations you should be aware of.
awk
$ gawk 'function die () { print "Aaaaarg!" } BEGIN { die () }' gawk: cmd. line:2: BEGIN { die () } gawk: cmd. line:2: ^ parse error $ gawk 'function die () { print "Aaaaarg!" } BEGIN { die() }' Aaaaarg! |
If you want your program to be deterministic, don't depend on for
on arrays:
$ cat for.awk END { arr["foo"] = 1 arr["bar"] = 1 for (i in arr) print i } $ gawk -f for.awk </dev/null foo bar $ nawk -f for.awk </dev/null bar foo |
Some AWK, such as HPUX 11.0's native one, have regex engines fragile to inner anchors:
$ echo xfoo | $AWK '/foo|^bar/ { print }' $ echo bar | $AWK '/foo|^bar/ { print }' bar $ echo xfoo | $AWK '/^bar|foo/ { print }' xfoo $ echo bar | $AWK '/^bar|foo/ { print }' bar |
Either do not depend on such patterns (i.e., use `/^(.*foo|bar)/', or use a simple test to reject such AWK.
cat
cc
HP-UX cc
doesn't accept `.S' files to preprocess and
assemble. `cc -c foo.S' will appear to succeed, but in fact does
nothing.
The default executable, produced by `cc foo.c', can be
gcc
).
gcc
.
cc
wrapper for DEC C on OpenVMS.
cmp
cmp
performs a raw data comparison of two files, while
diff
compares two text files. Therefore, if you might compare
DOS files, even if only checking whether two files are different, use
diff
to avoid spurious differences due to differences of
newline encoding.
cp
cp
does not support `-f', although its
mv
does. It's possible to deduce why mv
and
cp
are different with respect to `-f'. mv
prompts by default before overwriting a read-only file. cp
does not. Therefore, mv
requires a `-f' option, but
cp
does not. mv
and cp
behave differently
with respect to read-only files because the simplest form of
cp
cannot overwrite a read-only file, but the simplest form of
mv
can. This is because cp
opens the target for
write access, whereas mv
simply calls link
(or, in
newer systems, rename
).
Bob Proulx notes that `cp -p' always tries to copy
ownerships. But whether it actually does copy ownerships or not is a
system dependent policy decision implemented by the kernel. If the
kernel allows it then it happens. If the kernel does not allow it then
it does not happen. It is not something cp
itself has control
over.
In SysV any user can chown files to any other user, and SysV also had a
non-sticky `/tmp'. That undoubtedly derives from the heritage of
SysV in a business environment without hostile users. BSD changed this
to be a more secure model where only root can chown
files and
a sticky `/tmp' is used. That undoubtedly derives from the heritage
of BSD in a campus environment.
Linux by default follows BSD, but it can be configured to allow
chown
. HP-UX as an alternate example follows SysV, but it can
be configured to use the modern security model and disallow
chown
. Since it is an administrator configurable parameter
you can't use the name of the kernel as an indicator of the behavior.
date
date
do not recognize special % directives,
and unfortunately, instead of complaining, they just pass them through,
and exit with success:
$ uname -a OSF1 medusa.sis.pasteur.fr V5.1 732 alpha $ date "+%s" %s |
diff
Some implementations, such as Tru64's, fail when comparing to `/dev/null'. Use an empty file instead.
dirname
dirname
, and you should instead
use AS_DIRNAME
(see section 8.4 Programming in M4sh). For example:
dir=`dirname "$file"` # This is not portable. dir=`AS_DIRNAME(["$file"])` # This is more portable. |
This handles a few subtleties in the standard way required by POSIX. For example, under UN*X, should `dirname //1' give `/'? Paul Eggert answers:
No, under some older flavors of Unix, leading `//' is a special path name: it refers to a "super-root" and is used to access other machines' files. Leading `///', `////', etc. are equivalent to `/'; but leading `//' is special. I think this tradition started with Apollo Domain/OS, an OS that is still in use on some older hosts.POSIX allows but does not require the special treatment for `//'. It says that the behavior of dirname on path names of the form `//([^/]+/*)?' is implementation defined. In these cases, GNU
dirname
returns `/', but it's more portable to return `//' as this works even on those older flavors of Unix.
egrep
egrep
,
but many older hosts do not yet support the POSIX
replacement grep -E
. To work around this problem, invoke
AC_PROG_EGREP
and then use $EGREP
.
The empty alternative is not portable, use `?' instead. For instance with Digital Unix v5.0:
> printf "foo\n|foo\n" | $EGREP '^(|foo|bar)$' |foo > printf "bar\nbar|\n" | $EGREP '^(foo|bar|)$' bar| > printf "foo\nfoo|\n|bar\nbar\n" | $EGREP '^(foo||bar)$' foo |bar |
$EGREP
also suffers the limitations of grep
.
expr
expr
keyword starts with `x', so use `expr
x"word" : 'xregex'' to keep expr
from
misinterpreting word.
Don't use length
, substr
, match
and index
.
expr
(`|')
expr '' \| '' |
GNU/Linux and POSIX.2-1992 return the empty string for this case, but traditional UNIX returns `0' (Solaris is one such example). In POSIX.1-2001, the specification has been changed to match traditional UNIX's behavior (which is bizarre, but it's too late to fix this). Please note that the same problem does arise when the empty string results from a computation, as in:
expr bar : foo \| foo : bar |
Avoid this portability problem by avoiding the empty string.
expr
(`:')
The POSIX standard is ambiguous as to whether
`expr 'a' : '\(b\)'' outputs `0' or the empty string.
In practice, it outputs the empty string on most platforms, but portable
scripts should not assume this. For instance, the QNX 4.25 native
expr
returns `0'.
One might think that a way to get a uniform behavior would be to use the empty string as a default value:
expr a : '\(b\)' \| '' |
Unfortunately this behaves exactly as the original expression; see the
`expr
(`:')' entry for more information.
Older expr
implementations (e.g., SunOS 4 expr
and
Solaris 8 /usr/ucb/expr
) have a silly length limit that causes
expr
to fail if the matched substring is longer than 120
bytes. In this case, you might want to fall back on `echo|sed' if
expr
fails.
Don't leave, there is some more!
The QNX 4.25 expr
, in addition of preferring `0' to
the empty string, has a funny behavior in its exit status: it's always 1
when parentheses are used!
$ val=`expr 'a' : 'a'`; echo "$?: $val" 0: 1 $ val=`expr 'a' : 'b'`; echo "$?: $val" 1: 0 $ val=`expr 'a' : '\(a\)'`; echo "?: $val" 1: a $ val=`expr 'a' : '\(b\)'`; echo "?: $val" 1: 0 |
In practice this can be a big problem if you are ready to catch failures
of expr
programs with some other method (such as using
sed
), since you may get twice the result. For instance
$ expr 'a' : '\(a\)' || echo 'a' | sed 's/^\(a\)$/\1/' |
will output `a' on most hosts, but `aa' on QNX 4.25. A
simple workaround consists in testing expr
and use a variable
set to expr
or to false
according to the result.
fgrep
fgrep
,
but many older hosts do not yet support the POSIX
replacement grep -F
. To work around this problem, invoke
AC_PROG_FGREP
and then use $FGREP
.
find
find
commands do not understand it.
The replacement of `{}' is guaranteed only if the argument is exactly {}, not if it's only a part of an argument. For instance on DU, and HP-UX 10.20 and HP-UX 11:
$ touch foo $ find . -name foo -exec echo "{}-{}" \; {}-{} |
while GNU find
reports `./foo-./foo'.
grep
grep
to `/dev/null'. Check the exit
status of grep
to determine whether it found a match.
Don't use multiple regexps with `-e', as some grep
will only
honor the last pattern (e.g., IRIX 6.5 and Solaris 2.5.1). Anyway,
Stardent Vistra SVR4 grep
lacks `-e'... Instead, use
extended regular expressions and alternation.
Don't rely on `-w', as Irix 6.5.16m's grep
does not
support it.
ln
ln
having a `-f' option. Symbolic links
are not available on old systems; use `$(LN_S)' as a portable substitute.
For versions of the DJGPP before 2.04, ln
emulates soft links
to executables by generating a stub that in turn calls the real
program. This feature also works with nonexistent files like in the
Unix spec. So `ln -s file link' will generate `link.exe',
which will attempt to call `file.exe' if run. But this feature only
works for executables, so `cp -p' is used instead for these
systems. DJGPP versions 2.04 and later have full symlink support.
ls
ls
omits the group.
Modern practice is for all diagnostics to go to standard error, but
traditional `ls foo' prints the message `foo not found' to
standard output if `foo' does not exist. Be careful when writing
shell commands like `sources=`ls *.c 2>/dev/null`', since with
traditional ls
this is equivalent to `sources="*.c not
found"' if there are no `.c' files.
mkdir
mkdir
's options are portable. Instead of
`mkdir -p filename', you should use use
AS_MKDIR_P(filename)
(see section 8.4 Programming in M4sh).
mv
Moving individual files between file systems is portable (it was in V6), but it is not always atomic: when doing `mv new existing', there's a critical section where neither the old nor the new version of `existing' actually exists.
Be aware that moving files from `/tmp' can sometimes cause
undesirable (but perfectly valid) warnings, even if you created these
files. On some systems, creating the file in `/tmp' is setting a
guid wheel
which you may not be part of. So the file is copied,
and then the chgrp
fails:
$ touch /tmp/foo $ mv /tmp/foo . error-->mv: ./foo: set owner/group (was: 3830/0): Operation not permitted $ echo $? 0 $ ls foo foo |
This behavior conforms to POSIX:
If the duplication of the file characteristics fails for any reason, mv shall write a diagnostic message to standard error, but this failure shall not cause mv to modify its exit status."
Moving directories across mount points is not portable, use cp
and rm
.
Moving/Deleting open files isn't portable. The following can't be done on DOS/WIN32:
exec > foo mv foo bar |
nor can
exec > foo rm -f foo |
sed
sed
will reject `s/[^/]*$//': use `s,[^/]*$,,'.
Sed scripts should not use branch labels longer than 8 characters and should not contain comments.
Don't include extra `;', as some sed
, such as NetBSD
1.4.2's, try to interpret the second as a command:
$ echo a | sed 's/x/x/;;s/x/x/' sed: 1: "s/x/x/;;s/x/x/": invalid command code ; |
Input should have reasonably long lines, since some sed
have
an input buffer limited to 4000 bytes.
Alternation, `\|', is common but POSIX does not require its
support, so it should be avoided in portable scripts. Solaris 8
sed
does not support alternation; e.g., `sed '/a\|b/d''
deletes only lines that contain the literal string `a|b'.
Anchors (`^' and `$') inside groups are not portable.
Nested parenthesization in patterns (e.g., `\(\(a*\)b*)\)') is
quite portable to modern hosts, but is not supported by some older
sed
implementations like SVR3.
Of course the option `-e' is portable, but it is not needed. No valid Sed program can start with a dash, so it does not help disambiguating. Its sole usefulness is to help enforcing indentation as in:
sed -e instruction-1 \ -e instruction-2 |
as opposed to
sed instruction-1;instruction-2 |
Contrary to yet another urban legend, you may portably use `&' in
the replacement part of the s
command to mean "what was
matched". All descendants of Bell Lab's V7 sed
(at least; we
don't have first hand experience with older sed
s) have
supported it.
POSIX requires that you must not have any white space between `!' and the following command. It is OK to have blanks between the address and the `!'. For instance, on Solaris 8:
$ echo "foo" | sed -n '/bar/ ! p' error-->Unrecognized command: /bar/ ! p $ echo "foo" | sed -n '/bar/! p' error-->Unrecognized command: /bar/! p $ echo "foo" | sed -n '/bar/ !p' foo |
sed
(`t')
sed
that "forget" to reset their
`t' flag when starting a new cycle. For instance on MIPS
RISC/OS, and on IRIX 5.3, if you run the following sed
script (the line numbers are not actual part of the texts):
s/keep me/kept/g # a t end # b s/.*/deleted/g # c : end # d |
on
delete me # 1 delete me # 2 keep me # 3 delete me # 4 |
you get
deleted delete me kept deleted |
instead of
deleted deleted kept deleted |
Why? When processing 1, a matches, therefore sets the t flag, b jumps to
d, and the output is produced. When processing line 2, the t flag is
still set (this is the bug). Line a fails to match, but sed
is not supposed to clear the t flag when a substitution fails. Line b
sees that the flag is set, therefore it clears it, and jumps to d, hence
you get `delete me' instead of `deleted'. When processing 3, t
is clear, a matches, so the flag is set, hence b clears the flags and
jumps. Finally, since the flag is clear, 4 is processed properly.
There are two things one should remember about `t' in sed
.
Firstly, always remember that `t' jumps if some substitution
succeeded, not only the immediately preceding substitution. Therefore,
always use a fake `t clear; : clear' to reset the t flag where
indeed.
Secondly, you cannot rely on sed
to clear the flag at each new
cycle.
One portable implementation of the script above is:
t clear : clear s/keep me/kept/g t end s/.*/deleted/g : end |
touch
touch
or any command that
results in an empty file does not update the timestamps, so use a
command like echo
as a workaround.
GNU touch
3.16r (and presumably all before that)
fails to work on SunOS 4.1.3 when the empty file is on an
NFS-mounted 4.2 volume.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
make
itself suffers a great number of limitations, only a few
of which are listed here. First of all, remember that since commands
are executed by the shell, all its weaknesses are inherited....
$<
make
for instance
will replace it with the argument.
make
s don't support leading underscores in macro names,
such as on NEWS-OS 4.2R.
$ cat Makefile _am_include = # _am_quote = all:; @echo this is test $ make Make: Must be a separator on rules line 2. Stop. $ cat Makefile2 am_include = # am_quote = all:; @echo this is test $ make -f Makefile2 this is test |
make
will read multiple newlines
following a backslash, continuing to the next non-empty line. For
example,
FOO = one \ BAR = two test: : FOO is "$(FOO)" : BAR is "$(BAR)" |
shows FOO
equal to one BAR = two
. Other make
s
sensibly let a backslash continue only to the immediately following
line.
According to POSIX, `Makefile' comments start with #
and continue until an unescaped newline is reached.
% cat Makefile # A = foo \ bar \ baz all: @echo ok % make # GNU make ok |
However in Real World this is not always the case. Some implementations
discards anything from #
up to the end of line, ignoring any
trailing backslash.
% pmake # BSD make "Makefile", line 3: Need an operator Fatal errors encountered -- cannot continue |
Therefore, if you want to comment out a multi-line definition, prefix each
line with #
, not only the first.
# A = foo \ # bar \ # baz |
make macro=value
and sub-make
s.
A command-line variable definition such as foo=bar
overrides any
definition of foo
in the `Makefile'. Some make
implementations (such as GNU make
) will propagate this
override to sub-invocations of make
. This is allowed but not
required by POSIX.
% cat Makefile foo = foo one: @echo $(foo) $(MAKE) two two: @echo $(foo) % make foo=bar # GNU make 3.79.1 bar make two make[1]: Entering directory `/home/adl' bar make[1]: Leaving directory `/home/adl' % pmake foo=bar # BSD make bar pmake two foo |
You have a few possibilities if you do want the foo=bar
override
to propagate to sub-make
s. One is to use the -e
option, which causes all environment variables to have precedence over
the `Makefile' macro definitions, and declare foo as an environment
variable:
% env foo=bar make -e |
The -e
option is propagated to sub-make
s automatically,
and since the environment is inherited between make
invocations, the foo
macro will be overridden in
sub-make
s as expected.
Using -e
could have unexpected side-effects if your environment
contains some other macros usually defined by the Makefile. (See
also the note about make -e
and SHELL
below.)
Another way to propagate overrides to sub-make
s is to do it
manually, from your `Makefile':
foo = foo one: @echo $(foo) $(MAKE) foo=$(foo) two two: @echo $(foo) |
You need to foresee all macros that a user might want to override if you do that.
SHELL
macro
POSIX-compliant make
s internally use the $(SHELL)
macro to spawn shell processes and execute `Makefile' rules. This
is a builtin macro supplied by make
, but it can be modified
from the `Makefile' or a command-line argument.
Not all make
s will define this SHELL
macro. OSF/Tru64
make
is an example; this implementation will always use
/bin/sh
. So it's a good idea to always define SHELL
in
your `Makefile's. If you use Autoconf, do
SHELL = @SHELL@ |
POSIX-compliant make
s should never acquire the value of
$(SHELL) from the environment, even when make -e
is used
(otherwise, think about what would happen to your rules if
SHELL=/bin/tcsh
).
However not all make
implementations will make this exception.
For instance it's not surprising that OSF/Tru64 make
doesn't
protect SHELL
, since it doesn't use it.
% cat Makefile SHELL = /bin/sh FOO = foo all: @echo $(SHELL) @echo $(FOO) % env SHELL=/bin/tcsh FOO=bar make -e # OSF1 V4.0 Make /bin/tcsh bar % env SHELL=/bin/tcsh FOO=bar gmake -e # GNU make /bin/sh bar |
Never put comments in a rule.
Some make
treat anything starting with a tab as a command for
the current rule, even if the tab is immediately followed by a #
.
The make
from Tru64 Unix V5.1 is one of them. The following
`Makefile' will run # foo
through the shell.
all: # foo |
Never name one of your subdirectories `obj/' if you don't like surprises.
If an `obj/' directory exists, BSD make
will enter it
before reading `Makefile'. Hence the `Makefile' in the
current directory will not be read.
% cat Makefile all: echo Hello % cat obj/Makefile all: echo World % make # GNU make echo Hello Hello % pmake # BSD make echo World World |
make -k
Do not rely on the exit status of make -k
. Some implementations
reflect whether they encountered an error in their exit status; other
implementations always succeed.
% cat Makefile all: false % make -k; echo exit status: $? # GNU make false make: *** [all] Error 1 exit status: 2 % pmake -k; echo exit status: $? # BSD make false *** Error code 1 (continuing) exit status: 0 |
VPATH
There is no VPATH
support specified in POSIX. Many
make
s have a form of VPATH
support, but its
implementation is not consistent amongst make
s.
Maybe the best suggestion to give to people who need the VPATH
feature is to choose a make
implementation and stick to it.
Since the resulting `Makefile's are not portable anyway, better
choose a portable make
(hint, hint).
Here are a couple of known issues with some VPATH
implementations.
VPATH
and double-colon rules
Any assignment to VPATH
causes Sun make
to only execute
the first set of double-colon rules. (This comment has been here since
1994 and the context has been lost. It's probably about SunOS 4. If
you can reproduce this, please send us a test case for illustration.)
$<
in inference rules:
make
would not prefix $<
if this
prerequisite has been found in a VPATH
dir. This means that
VPATH = ../src .c.o: cc -c $< -o $@ |
would run cc -c foo.c -o foo.o
, even if `foo.c' was actually
found in `../src/'.
This can be fixed as follows.
VPATH = ../src .c.o: cc -c `test -f $< || echo ../src/`$< -o $@ |
This kludge was introduced in Automake in 2000, but the exact context
have been lost. If you know which make
implementation is
involved here, please drop us a note.
$<
not supported in explicit rules
As said elsewhere, using $<
in explicit rules is not portable.
The prerequisite file must be named explicitly in the rule. If you want
to find the prerequisite via a VPATH
search, you have to code the
whole thing manually. For instance, using the same pattern as above:
VPATH = ../src foo.o: foo.c cc -c `test -f foo.c || echo ../src/`foo.c -o foo.o |
Some make
implementations, such as SunOS make
, will
search prerequisites in VPATH
and rewrite all their occurrences
in the rule appropriately.
For instance
VPATH = ../src foo.o: foo.c cc -c foo.c -o foo.o |
would execute cc -c ../src/foo.c -o foo.o
if `foo.c' was
found in `../src'. That sounds great.
However, for the sake of other make
implementations, we can't
rely on this, and we have to search VPATH
manually:
VPATH = ../src foo.o: foo.c cc -c `test -f foo.c || echo ../src/`foo.c -o foo.o |
However the "prerequisite rewriting" still applies here. So if
`foo.c' is in `../src', SunOS make
will execute
|
which reduces to
cc -c foo.c -o foo.o |
and thus fails. Oops.
One workaround is to make sure that foo.c never appears as a plain word in the rule. For instance these three rules would be safe.
VPATH = ../src foo.o: foo.c cc -c `test -f ./foo.c || echo ../src/`foo.c -o foo.o foo2.o: foo2.c cc -c `test -f 'foo2.c' || echo ../src/`foo2.c -o foo2.o foo3.o: foo3.c cc -c `test -f "foo3.c" || echo ../src/`foo3.c -o foo3.o |
Things get worse when your prerequisites are in a macro.
VPATH = ../src HEADERS = foo.h foo2.h foo3.h install-HEADERS: $(HEADERS) for i in $(HEADERS); do \ $(INSTALL) -m 644 `test -f $$i || echo ../src/`$$i \ $(DESTDIR)$(includedir)/$$i; \ done |
The above install-HEADERS
rule is not SunOS-proof because for
i in $(HEADERS);
will be expanded as for i in foo.h foo2.h foo3.h;
where foo.h
and foo2.h
are plain words and are hence
subject to VPATH
adjustments.
If the three files are in `../src', the rule is run as:
for i in ../src/foo.h ../src/foo2.h foo3.h; do \ install -m 644 `test -f $i || echo ../src/`$i \ /usr/local/include/$i; \ done |
where the two first install
calls will fail. For instance,
consider the foo.h
installation:
install -m 644 `test -f ../src/foo.h || echo ../src/`../src/foo.h \ /usr/local/include/../src/foo.h; |
install -m 644 ../src/foo.h /usr/local/include/../src/foo.h; |
Note that the manual VPATH
search did not cause any problems here;
however this command installs `foo.h' in an incorrect directory.
Trying to quote $(HEADERS)
in some way, as we did for
foo.c
a few `Makefile's ago, does not help:
install-HEADERS: $(HEADERS) headers='$(HEADERS)'; for i in $$headers; do \ $(INSTALL) -m 644 `test -f $$i || echo ../src/`$$i \ $(DESTDIR)$(includedir)/$$i; \ done |
Indeed, headers='$(HEADERS)'
expands to headers='foo.h
foo2.h foo3.h'
where foo2.h
is still a plain word. (Aside: the
headers='$(HEADERS)'; for i in $$headers;
idiom is a good
idea if $(HEADERS)
can be empty, because some shell produce a
syntax error on for i in;
.)
One workaround is to strip this unwanted `../src/' prefix manually:
VPATH = ../src HEADERS = foo.h foo2.h foo3.h install-HEADERS: $(HEADERS) headers='$(HEADERS)'; for i in $$headers; do \ i=`expr "$$i" : '../src/\(.*\)'`; $(INSTALL) -m 644 `test -f $$i || echo ../src/`$$i \ $(DESTDIR)$(includedir)/$$i; \ done |
make
creates prerequisite directories magically
When a prerequisite is a sub-directory of VPATH
, Tru64
make
will create it in the current directory.
% mkdir -p foo/bar build % cd build % cat >Makefile <<END VPATH = .. all: foo/bar END % make mkdir foo mkdir foo/bar |
This can yield unexpected results if a rule uses a manual VPATH
search as presented before.
VPATH = .. all : foo/bar command `test -d foo/bar || echo ../`foo/bar |
The above command
will be run on the empty `foo/bar'
directory that was created in the current directory.
GNU make
uses a rather complex algorithm to decide when it
should use files found via a VPATH
search. See section `How Directory Searches are Performed' in The GNU Make Manual.
If a target needs to be rebuilt, GNU make
discards the
filename found during the VPATH
search for this target, and
builds the file locally using the filename given in the `Makefile'.
If a target does not need to be rebuilt, GNU make
uses the
filename found during the VPATH
search.
Other make
implementations, like BSD make
, are
easier to describe: the filename found during the VPATH
search
will be used whether the target needs to be rebuilt or not. Therefore
new files are created locally, but existing files are updated at their
VPATH
location.
When attempting a VPATH
build for an autoconfiscated package
(e.g, mkdir build; ../configure
), this means the GNU
make
will build everything locally in the `build'
directory, while BSD make
will build new files locally and
update existing files in the source directory.
% cat Makefile VPATH = .. all: foo.x bar.x foo.x bar.x: newer.x @echo Building $@ % touch ../bar.x % touch ../newer.x % make # GNU make Building foo.x Building bar.x % pmake # BSD make Building foo.x Building ../bar.x |
Another point worth mentioning is that once GNU make
has
decided to ignore a VPATH
filename (e.g., it ignored
`../bar.x' in the above example) it will continue to ignore it when
the target occurs as a prerequisite of another rule.
The following example shows that GNU make
does not look up
`bar.x' in VPATH
before performing the .x.y
rule,
because it ignored the VPATH
result of `bar.x' while running
the bar.x: newer.x
rule.
% cat Makefile VPATH = .. all: bar.y bar.x: newer.x @echo Building $@ .SUFFIXES: .x .y .x.y: cp $< $@ % touch ../bar.x % touch ../newer.x % make # GNU make Building bar.x cp bar.x bar.y cp: cannot stat `bar.x': No such file or directory make: *** [bar.y] Error 1 % pmake # BSD make Building ../bar.x cp ../bar.x bar.y |
Note that if you drop away the command from the bar.x: newer.x
rule, things will magically start to work: GNU
make
knows that bar.x
hasn't been updated, therefore
it doesn't discard the result from VPATH
(`../bar.x') in
succeeding uses.
% cat Makefile VPATH = .. all: bar.y bar.x: newer.x .SUFFIXES: .x .y .x.y: cp $< $@ % touch ../bar.x % touch ../newer.x % make # GNU make cp ../bar.x bar.y % rm bar.y % pmake # BSD make cp ../bar.x bar.y |
Separated dependencies simply refers to listing the prerequisite of a target, without defining a rule. Usually one can list on the one hand side, the rules, and on the other hand side, the dependencies.
Solaris make
does not support separated dependencies for
targets defined by single suffix rules:
$ cat Makefile .SUFFIXES: .in foo: foo.in .in: cp $< $ $ touch foo.in $ make $ ls Makefile foo.in |
while GNU Make does:
$ gmake cp foo.in foo $ ls Makefile foo foo.in |
Note it works without the `foo: foo.in' dependency.
$ cat Makefile .SUFFIXES: .in .in: cp $< $ $ make foo cp foo.in foo |
and it works with double suffix inference rules:
$ cat Makefile foo.out: foo.in .SUFFIXES: .in .out .in.out: cp $< $ $ make cp foo.in foo.out |
As a result, in such a case, you have to write target rules.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
A few kinds of features can't be guessed automatically by running test
programs. For example, the details of the object-file format, or
special options that need to be passed to the compiler or linker. You
can check for such features using ad-hoc means, such as having
configure
check the output of the uname
program, or
looking for libraries that are unique to particular systems. However,
Autoconf provides a uniform method for handling unguessable features.
11.1 Specifying the System Type Specifying the system type 11.2 Getting the Canonical System Type Getting the canonical system type 11.3 Using the System Type What to do with the system type
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Like other GNU configure
scripts, Autoconf-generated
configure
scripts can make decisions based on a canonical name
for the system type, which has the form:
`cpu-vendor-os', where os can be
`system' or `kernel-system'
configure
can usually guess the canonical name for the type of
system it's running on. To do so it runs a script called
config.guess
, which infers the name using the uname
command or symbols predefined by the C preprocessor.
Alternately, the user can specify the system type with command line
arguments to configure
. Doing so is necessary when
cross-compiling. In the most complex case of cross-compiling, three
system types are involved. The options to specify them are:
config.guess
.
If you mean to override the result of config.guess
, use
`--build', not `--host', since the latter enables
cross-compilation. For historical reasons, passing `--host' also
changes the build type. Therefore, whenever you specify --host
,
be sure to specify --build
too. This will be fixed in the
future.
./configure --build=i686-pc-linux-gnu --host=m68k-coff |
will enter cross-compilation mode, but configure
will fail if it
can't run the code generated by the specified compiler if you configure
as follows:
./configure CC=m68k-coff-gcc |
configure
recognizes short aliases for many system types; for
example, `decstation' can be used instead of
`mips-dec-ultrix4.2'. configure
runs a script called
config.sub
to canonicalize system type aliases.
This section deliberately omits the description of the obsolete interface; see 15.6.3 Hosts and Cross-Compilation.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
The following macros make the system type available to configure
scripts.
The variables `build_alias', `host_alias', and
`target_alias' are always exactly the arguments of `--build',
`--host', and `--target'; in particular, they are left empty
if the user did not use them, even if the corresponding
AC_CANONICAL
macro was run. Any configure script may use these
variables anywhere. These are the variables that should be used when in
interaction with the user.
If you need to recognize some special environments based on their system type, run the following macros to get canonical system names. These variables are not set before the macro call.
If you use these macros, you must distribute config.guess
and
config.sub
along with your source code. See section 4.4 Outputting Files, for
information about the AC_CONFIG_AUX_DIR
macro which you can use
to control in which directory configure
looks for those scripts.
build
, and its
three individual parts build_cpu
, build_vendor
, and
build_os
.
If `--build' was specified, then build
is the
canonicalization of build_alias
by config.sub
,
otherwise it is determined by the shell script config.guess
.
host
, and its
three individual parts host_cpu
, host_vendor
, and
host_os
.
If `--host' was specified, then host
is the
canonicalization of host_alias
by config.sub
,
otherwise it defaults to build
.
target
, and its
three individual parts target_cpu
, target_vendor
, and
target_os
.
If `--target' was specified, then target
is the
canonicalization of target_alias
by config.sub
,
otherwise it defaults to host
.
Note that there can be artifacts due to the backward compatibility code. See See section 15.6.3 Hosts and Cross-Compilation, for more.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
How do you use a canonical system type? Usually, you use it in one or
more case
statements in `configure.ac' to select
system-specific C files. Then, using AC_CONFIG_LINKS
, link those
files which have names based on the system name, to generic names, such
as `host.h' or `target.c' (see section 4.10 Creating Configuration Links). The
case
statement patterns can use shell wild cards to group several
cases together, like in this fragment:
case $target in i386-*-mach* | i386-*-gnu*) obj_format=aout emulation=mach bfd_gas=yes ;; i960-*-bout) obj_format=bout ;; esac |
and later in `configure.ac', use:
AC_CONFIG_LINKS(host.h:config/$machine.h object.h:config/$obj_format.h) |
Note that the above example uses $target
because it's taken from
a tool which can be built on some architecture ($build
), run on
another ($host
), but yet handle data for a third architecture
($target
). Such tools are usually part of a compiler suite, they
generate code for a specific $target
.
However $target
should be meaningless for most packages. If you
want to base a decision on the system where your program will be run,
make sure you use the $host
variable, as in the following
excerpt:
case $host in *-*-msdos* | *-*-go32* | *-*-mingw32* | *-*-cygwin* | *-*-windows*) MUMBLE_INIT="mumble.ini" ;; *) MUMBLE_INIT=".mumbleinit" ;; esac AC_SUBST([MUMBLE_INIT]) |
You can also use the host system type to find cross-compilation tools.
See section 5.2.2 Generic Program and File Checks, for information about the AC_CHECK_TOOL
macro which does that.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
configure
scripts support several kinds of local configuration
decisions. There are ways for users to specify where external software
packages are, include or exclude optional features, install programs
under modified names, and set default values for configure
options.
12.1 Working With External Software Working with other optional software 12.2 Choosing Package Options Selecting optional features 12.3 Making Your Help Strings Look Pretty Formatting help string 12.4 Configuring Site Details Configuring site details 12.5 Transforming Program Names When Installing Changing program names when installing 12.6 Setting Site Defaults Giving configure
local defaults
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Some packages require, or can optionally use, other software packages
that are already installed. The user can give configure
command line options to specify which such external software to use.
The options have one of these forms:
--with-package[=arg] --without-package |
For example, `--with-gnu-ld' means work with the GNU linker instead of some other linker. `--with-x' means work with The X Window System.
The user can give an argument by following the package name with `=' and the argument. Giving an argument of `no' is for packages that are used by default; it says to not use the package. An argument that is neither `yes' nor `no' could include a name or number of a version of the other package, to specify more precisely which other package this program is supposed to work with. If no argument is given, it defaults to `yes'. `--without-package' is equivalent to `--with-package=no'.
configure
scripts do not complain about
`--with-package' options that they do not support. This
behavior permits configuring a source tree containing multiple packages
with a top-level configure
script when the packages support
different options, without spurious error messages about options that
some of the packages support. An unfortunate side effect is that option
spelling errors are not diagnosed. No better approach to this problem
has been suggested so far.
For each external software package that may be used, `configure.ac'
should call AC_ARG_WITH
to detect whether the configure
user asked to use it. Whether each package is used or not by default,
and which arguments are valid, is up to you.
configure
the option `--with-package'
or `--without-package', run shell commands
action-if-given. If neither option was given, run shell commands
action-if-not-given. The name package indicates another
software package that this program should work with. It should consist
only of alphanumeric characters and dashes.
The option's argument is available to the shell commands
action-if-given in the shell variable withval
, which is
actually just the value of the shell variable with_package
,
with any `-' characters changed into `_'. You may use that
variable instead, if you wish.
The argument help-string is a description of the option that looks like this:
--with-readline support fancy command line editing |
help-string may be more than one line long, if more detail is needed. Just make sure the columns line up in `configure --help'. Avoid tabs in the help string. You'll need to enclose the help string in `[' and `]' in order to produce the leading spaces.
You should format your help-string with the macro
AC_HELP_STRING
(see section 12.3 Making Your Help Strings Look Pretty).
AC_ARG_WITH
that does not
support providing a help string.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
If a software package has optional compile-time features, the user can
give configure
command line options to specify whether to
compile them. The options have one of these forms:
--enable-feature[=arg] --disable-feature |
These options allow users to choose which optional features to build and install. `--enable-feature' options should never make a feature behave differently or cause one feature to replace another. They should only cause parts of the program to be built rather than left out.
The user can give an argument by following the feature name with `=' and the argument. Giving an argument of `no' requests that the feature not be made available. A feature with an argument looks like `--enable-debug=stabs'. If no argument is given, it defaults to `yes'. `--disable-feature' is equivalent to `--enable-feature=no'.
configure
scripts do not complain about
`--enable-feature' options that they do not support.
This behavior permits configuring a source tree containing multiple
packages with a top-level configure
script when the packages
support different options, without spurious error messages about options
that some of the packages support.
An unfortunate side effect is that option spelling errors are not diagnosed.
No better approach to this problem has been suggested so far.
For each optional feature, `configure.ac' should call
AC_ARG_ENABLE
to detect whether the configure
user asked
to include it. Whether each feature is included or not by default, and
which arguments are valid, is up to you.
configure
the option
`--enable-feature' or `--disable-feature', run
shell commands action-if-given. If neither option was given, run
shell commands action-if-not-given. The name feature
indicates an optional user-level facility. It should consist only of
alphanumeric characters and dashes.
The option's argument is available to the shell commands
action-if-given in the shell variable enableval
, which is
actually just the value of the shell variable
enable_feature
, with any `-' characters changed into
`_'. You may use that variable instead, if you wish. The
help-string argument is like that of AC_ARG_WITH
(see section 12.1 Working With External Software).
You should format your help-string with the macro
AC_HELP_STRING
(see section 12.3 Making Your Help Strings Look Pretty).
AC_ARG_ENABLE
that does not
support providing a help string.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Properly formatting the `help strings' which are used in
AC_ARG_WITH
(see section 12.1 Working With External Software) and AC_ARG_ENABLE
(see section 12.2 Choosing Package Options) can be challenging. Specifically, you want
your own `help strings' to line up in the appropriate columns of
`configure --help' just like the standard Autoconf `help
strings' do. This is the purpose of the AC_HELP_STRING
macro.
Expands into an help string that looks pretty when the user executes
`configure --help'. It is typically used in AC_ARG_WITH
(see section 12.1 Working With External Software) or AC_ARG_ENABLE
(see section 12.2 Choosing Package Options). The following example will make this clearer.
AC_DEFUN([TEST_MACRO], [AC_ARG_WITH([foo], AC_HELP_STRING([--with-foo], [use foo (default is NO)]), [ac_cv_use_foo=$withval], [ac_cv_use_foo=no]) AC_CACHE_CHECK([whether to use foo], [ac_cv_use_foo], [ac_cv_use_foo=no])]) |
Please note that the call to AC_HELP_STRING
is unquoted.
Then the last few lines of `configure --help' will appear like
this:
--enable and --with options recognized: --with-foo use foo (default is NO) |
The AC_HELP_STRING
macro is particularly helpful when the
left-hand-side and/or right-hand-side are composed of macro
arguments, as shown in the following example.
AC_DEFUN(MY_ARG_WITH, [AC_ARG_WITH([$1], AC_HELP_STRING([--with-$1], [use $1 (default is $2)]), ac_cv_use_$1=$withval, ac_cv_use_$1=no), AC_CACHE_CHECK(whether to use $1, ac_cv_use_$1, ac_cv_use_$1=$2)]) |
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Some software packages require complex site-specific information. Some examples are host names to use for certain services, company names, and email addresses to contact. Since some configuration scripts generated by Metaconfig ask for such information interactively, people sometimes wonder how to get that information in Autoconf-generated configuration scripts, which aren't interactive.
Such site configuration information should be put in a file that is
edited only by users, not by programs. The location of the file
can either be based on the prefix
variable, or be a standard
location such as the user's home directory. It could even be specified
by an environment variable. The programs should examine that file at
run time, rather than at compile time. Run-time configuration is more
convenient for users and makes the configuration process simpler than
getting the information while configuring. See section `Variables for Installation Directories' in GNU Coding Standards, for more information on where to put data files.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Autoconf supports changing the names of programs when installing them.
In order to use these transformations, `configure.ac' must call the
macro AC_ARG_PROGRAM
.
program_transform_name
a sequence of
sed
commands for changing the names of installed programs.
If any of the options described below are given to configure
,
program names are transformed accordingly. Otherwise, if
AC_CANONICAL_TARGET
has been called and a `--target' value
is given, the target type followed by a dash is used as a prefix.
Otherwise, no program name transformation is done.
12.5.1 Transformation Options configure
options to transform names12.5.2 Transformation Examples Sample uses of transforming names 12.5.3 Transformation Rules `Makefile' uses of transforming names
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
You can specify name transformations by giving configure
these
command line options:
sed
substitution expression on the names.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
These transformations are useful with programs that can be part of a cross-compilation development environment. For example, a cross-assembler running on a Sun 4 configured with `--target=i960-vxworks' is normally installed as `i960-vxworks-as', rather than `as', which could be confused with a native Sun 4 assembler.
You can force a program name to begin with `g', if you don't want
GNU programs installed on your system to shadow other programs with
the same name. For example, if you configure GNU diff
with
`--program-prefix=g', then when you run `make install' it is
installed as `/usr/local/bin/gdiff'.
As a more sophisticated example, you could use
--program-transform-name='s/^/g/; s/^gg/g/; s/^gless/less/' |
to prepend `g' to most of the program names in a source tree,
excepting those like gdb
that already have one and those like
less
and lesskey
that aren't GNU programs. (That is
assuming that you have a source tree containing those programs that is
set up to use this feature.)
One way to install multiple versions of some programs simultaneously is to append a version number to the name of one or both. For example, if you want to keep Autoconf version 1 around for awhile, you can configure Autoconf version 2 using `--program-suffix=2' to install the programs as `/usr/local/bin/autoconf2', `/usr/local/bin/autoheader2', etc. Nevertheless, pay attention that only the binaries are renamed, therefore you'd have problems with the library files which might overlap.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Here is how to use the variable program_transform_name
in a
`Makefile.in':
PROGRAMS = cp ls rm transform = @program_transform_name@ install: for p in $(PROGRAMS); do \ $(INSTALL_PROGRAM) $$p $(DESTDIR)$(bindir)/`echo $$p | \ sed '$(transform)'`; \ done uninstall: for p in $(PROGRAMS); do \ rm -f $(DESTDIR)$(bindir)/`echo $$p | sed '$(transform)'`; \ done |
It is guaranteed that program_transform_name
is never empty, and
that there are no useless separators. Therefore you may safely embed
program_transform_name
within a sed program using `;':
transform = @program_transform_name@ transform_exe = s/$(EXEEXT)$$//;$(transform);s/$$/$(EXEEXT)/ |
Whether to do the transformations on documentation files (Texinfo or
man
) is a tricky question; there seems to be no perfect answer,
due to the several reasons for name transforming. Documentation is not
usually particular to a specific architecture, and Texinfo files do not
conflict with system documentation. But they might conflict with
earlier versions of the same files, and man
pages sometimes do
conflict with system documentation. As a compromise, it is probably
best to do name transformations on man
pages but not on Texinfo
manuals.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Autoconf-generated configure
scripts allow your site to provide
default values for some configuration values. You do this by creating
site- and system-wide initialization files.
If the environment variable CONFIG_SITE
is set, configure
uses its value as the name of a shell script to read. Otherwise, it
reads the shell script `prefix/share/config.site' if it exists,
then `prefix/etc/config.site' if it exists. Thus,
settings in machine-specific files override those in machine-independent
ones in case of conflict.
Site files can be arbitrary shell scripts, but only certain kinds of
code are really appropriate to be in them. Because configure
reads any cache file after it has read any site files, a site file can
define a default cache file to be shared between all Autoconf-generated
configure
scripts run on that system (see section 7.3.2 Cache Files). If
you set a default cache file in a site file, it is a good idea to also
set the output variable CC
in that site file, because the cache
file is only valid for a particular compiler, but many systems have
several available.
You can examine or override the value set by a command line option to
configure
in a site file; options set shell variables that have
the same names as the options, with any dashes turned into underscores.
The exceptions are that `--without-' and `--disable-' options
are like giving the corresponding `--with-' or `--enable-'
option and the value `no'. Thus, `--cache-file=localcache'
sets the variable cache_file
to the value `localcache';
`--enable-warnings=no' or `--disable-warnings' sets the variable
enable_warnings
to the value `no'; `--prefix=/usr' sets the
variable prefix
to the value `/usr'; etc.
Site files are also good places to set default values for other output
variables, such as CFLAGS
, if you need to give them non-default
values: anything you would normally do, repetitively, on the command
line. If you use non-default values for prefix or
exec_prefix (wherever you locate the site file), you can set them
in the site file if you specify it with the CONFIG_SITE
environment variable.
You can set some cache values in the site file itself. Doing this is
useful if you are cross-compiling, where it is impossible to check features
that require running a test program. You could "prime the cache" by
setting those values correctly for that system in
`prefix/etc/config.site'. To find out the names of the cache
variables you need to set, look for shell variables with `_cv_' in
their names in the affected configure
scripts, or in the Autoconf
M4 source code for those macros.
The cache file is careful to not override any variables set in the site
files. Similarly, you should not override command-line options in the
site files. Your code should check that variables such as prefix
and cache_file
have their default values (as set near the top of
configure
) before changing them.
Here is a sample file `/usr/share/local/gnu/share/config.site'. The
command `configure --prefix=/usr/share/local/gnu' would read this
file (if CONFIG_SITE
is not set to a different file).
# config.site for configure # # Change some defaults. test "$prefix" = NONE && prefix=/usr/share/local/gnu test "$exec_prefix" = NONE && exec_prefix=/usr/local/gnu test "$sharedstatedir" = '$prefix/com' && sharedstatedir=/var test "$localstatedir" = '$prefix/var' && localstatedir=/var # Give Autoconf 2.x generated configure scripts a shared default # cache file for feature test results, architecture-specific. if test "$cache_file" = /dev/null; then cache_file="$prefix/var/config.cache" # A cache file is only valid for one C compiler. CC=gcc fi |
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
configure
Scripts
Below are instructions on how to configure a package that uses a
configure
script, suitable for inclusion as an `INSTALL'
file in the package. A plain-text version of `INSTALL' which you
may use comes with Autoconf.
13.1 Basic Installation Instructions for typical cases 13.2 Compilers and Options Selecting compilers and optimization 13.3 Compiling For Multiple Architectures Compiling for multiple architectures at once 13.4 Installation Names Installing in different directories 13.5 Optional Features Selecting optional features 13.6 Specifying the System Type Specifying the system type 13.7 Sharing Defaults Setting site-wide defaults for configure
13.8 Defining Variables Specifying the compiler etc. 13.9 configure
InvocationChanging how configure
runs
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
These are generic installation instructions.
The configure
shell script attempts to guess correct values
for various system-dependent variables used during compilation. It uses
those values to create a `Makefile' in each directory of the
package. It may also create one or more `.h' files containing
system-dependent definitions. Finally, it creates a shell script
`config.status' that you can run in the future to recreate the
current configuration, and a file `config.log' containing compiler
output (useful mainly for debugging configure
).
It can also use an optional file (typically called `config.cache' and enabled with `--cache-file=config.cache' or simply `-C') that saves the results of its tests to speed up reconfiguring. (Caching is disabled by default to prevent problems with accidental use of stale cache files.)
If you need to do unusual things to compile the package, please try to
figure out how configure
could check whether to do them, and
mail diffs or instructions to the address given in the `README' so
they can be considered for the next release. If you are using the
cache, and at some point `config.cache' contains results you don't
want to keep, you may remove or edit it.
The file `configure.ac' (or `configure.in') is used to create
`configure' by a program called autoconf
. You only need
`configure.ac' if you want to change it or regenerate
`configure' using a newer version of autoconf
.
The simplest way to compile this package is:
cd
to the directory containing the package's source code and type
`./configure' to configure the package for your system. If you're
using csh
on an old version of System V, you might need to type
`sh ./configure' instead to prevent csh
from trying to
execute configure
itself.
Running configure
takes awhile. While running, it prints some
messages telling which features it is checking for.
configure
created (so you can compile the package for a
different kind of computer), type `make distclean'. There is also
a `make maintainer-clean' target, but that is intended mainly for
the package's developers. If you use it, you may have to get all sorts
of other programs in order to regenerate files that came with the
distribution.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Some systems require unusual options for compilation or linking that the
configure
script does not know about. Run `./configure
--help' for details on some of the pertinent environment variables.
You can give configure
initial values for configuration
parameters by setting variables in the command line or in the environment.
Here is an example:
./configure CC=c89 CFLAGS=-O2 LIBS=-lposix |
See section 13.8 Defining Variables, for more details.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
You can compile the package for more than one kind of computer at the
same time, by placing the object files for each architecture in their
own directory. To do this, you must use a version of make
that supports the VPATH
variable, such as GNU make
.
cd
to the directory where you want the object files and
executables to go and run the configure
script.
configure
automatically checks for the source code in the
directory that configure
is in and in `..'.
If you have to use a make
that does not support the
VPATH
variable, you have to compile the package for one
architecture at a time in the source code directory. After you have
installed the package for one architecture, use `make distclean'
before reconfiguring for another architecture.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
By default, `make install' will install the package's files in
`/usr/local/bin', `/usr/local/man', etc. You can specify an
installation prefix other than `/usr/local' by giving
configure
the option `--prefix=path'.
You can specify separate installation prefixes for architecture-specific
files and architecture-independent files. If you give
configure
the option `--exec-prefix=path', the
package will use path as the prefix for installing programs and
libraries. Documentation and other data files will still use the
regular prefix.
In addition, if you use an unusual directory layout you can give options like `--bindir=path' to specify different values for particular kinds of files. Run `configure --help' for a list of the directories you can set and what kinds of files go in them.
If the package supports it, you can cause programs to be installed with
an extra prefix or suffix on their names by giving configure
the option `--program-prefix=PREFIX' or
`--program-suffix=SUFFIX'.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Some packages pay attention to `--enable-feature' options
to configure
, where feature indicates an optional part
of the package. They may also pay attention to
`--with-package' options, where package is something
like `gnu-as' or `x' (for the X Window System). The
`README' should mention any `--enable-' and `--with-'
options that the package recognizes.
For packages that use the X Window System, configure
can
usually find the X include and library files automatically, but if it
doesn't, you can use the configure
options
`--x-includes=dir' and `--x-libraries=dir' to
specify their locations.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
There may be some features configure
cannot figure out
automatically, but needs to determine by the type of machine the package
will run on. Usually, assuming the package is built to be run on the
same architectures, configure
can figure that out, but
if it prints a message saying it cannot guess the machine type, give it
the `--build=type' option. type can either be a
short name for the system type, such as `sun4', or a canonical name
which has the form:
cpu-company-system |
where system can have one of these forms:
os kernel-os |
See the file `config.sub' for the possible values of each field. If `config.sub' isn't included in this package, then this package doesn't need to know the machine type.
If you are building compiler tools for cross-compiling, you should use the `--target=type' option to select the type of system they will produce code for.
If you want to use a cross compiler, that generates code for a platform different from the build platform, you should specify the host platform (i.e., that on which the generated programs will eventually be run) with `--host=type'.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
If you want to set default values for configure
scripts to
share, you can create a site shell script called `config.site' that
gives default values for variables like CC
, cache_file
,
and prefix
. configure
looks for
`prefix/share/config.site' if it exists, then
`prefix/etc/config.site' if it exists. Or, you can set the
CONFIG_SITE
environment variable to the location of the site
script. A warning: not all configure
scripts look for a site
script.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Variables not defined in a site shell script can be set in the
environment passed to configure
. However, some packages may
run configure again during the build, and the customized values of these
variables may be lost. In order to avoid this problem, you should set
them in the configure
command line, using `VAR=value'.
For example:
./configure CC=/usr/local2/bin/gcc |
will cause the specified gcc to be used as the C compiler (unless it is overridden in the site shell script).
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
configure
Invocation
configure
recognizes the following options to control how it
operates.
configure
, and exit.
configure
script, and exit.
configure
can determine that directory automatically.
configure
also accepts some other, not widely useful, options.
Run `configure --help' for more details.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
The configure
script creates a file named `config.status',
which actually configures, instantiates, the template files. It
also records the configuration options that were specified when the
package was last configured in case reconfiguring is needed.
Synopsis:
./config.status option... [file...] |
It configures the files; if none are specified, all the templates are instantiated. The files must be specified without their dependencies, as in
./config.status foobar |
not
./config.status foobar:foo.in:bar.in |
The supported options are:
This option and the following ones provide one way for separately
distributed packages to share the values computed by configure
.
Doing so can be useful if some of the packages need a superset of the
features that one of them, perhaps a common library, does. These
options allow a `config.status' file to create files other than the
ones that its `configure.ac' specifies, so it can be used for a
different package.
configure
, so that the
results of some tests might be different from the previous run. The
`--recheck' option re-runs configure
with the same arguments
you used before, plus the `--no-create' option, which prevents
configure
from running `config.status' and creating
`Makefile' and other files, and the `--no-recursion' option,
which prevents configure
from running other configure
scripts in subdirectories. (This is so other `Makefile' rules can
run `config.status' when it changes; see section 4.7.4 Automatic Remaking,
for an example).
`config.status' checks several optional environment variables that can alter its behavior:
configure
for the `--recheck'
option. It must be Bourne-compatible. The default is a shell that
supports LINENO
if available, and `/bin/sh' otherwise.
configure
scripts shouldn't be merged because they are maintained separately.
You can use `./config.status' in your Makefiles. For example, in the dependencies given above (see section 4.7.4 Automatic Remaking), `config.status' is run twice when `configure.ac' has changed. If that bothers you, you can make each run only regenerate the files for that rule:
config.h: stamp-h stamp-h: config.h.in config.status ./config.status config.h echo > stamp-h Makefile: Makefile.in config.status ./config.status Makefile |
The calling convention of `config.status' has changed; see 15.1 Obsolete `config.status' Invocation, for details.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Autoconf changes, and throughout the years some constructs have been obsoleted. Most of the changes involve the macros, but in some cases the tools themselves, or even some concepts, are now considered obsolete.
You may completely skip this chapter if you are new to Autoconf. Its intention is mainly to help maintainers updating their packages by understanding how to move to more modern constructs.
15.1 Obsolete `config.status' Invocation Different calling convention 15.2 `acconfig.h' Additional entries in `config.h.in' 15.3 Using autoupdate
to Modernize `configure.ac'Automatic update of `configure.ac' 15.4 Obsolete Macros Backward compatibility macros 15.5 Upgrading From Version 1 Tips for upgrading your files 15.6 Upgrading From Version 2.13 Some fresher tips
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
`config.status' now supports arguments to specify the files to instantiate; see 14. Recreating a Configuration, for more details. Before, environment variables had to be used.
AC_OUTPUT
and AC_CONFIG_COMMANDS
in
`configure.ac'.
AC_OUTPUT
and
AC_CONFIG_FILES
in `configure.ac'.
#define
statements. The
default is the arguments given to AC_CONFIG_HEADERS
; if that
macro was not called, `config.status' ignores this variable.
AC_CONFIG_LINKS
; if that macro was not called,
`config.status' ignores this variable.
In 14. Recreating a Configuration, using this old interface, the example would be:
config.h: stamp-h stamp-h: config.h.in config.status CONFIG_COMMANDS= CONFIG_LINKS= CONFIG_FILES= \ CONFIG_HEADERS=config.h ./config.status echo > stamp-h Makefile: Makefile.in config.status CONFIG_COMMANDS= CONFIG_LINKS= CONFIG_HEADERS= \ CONFIG_FILES=Makefile ./config.status |
(If `configure.ac' does not call AC_CONFIG_HEADERS
, there is
no need to set CONFIG_HEADERS
in the make
rules. Equally
for CONFIG_COMMANDS
etc.)
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
In order to produce `config.h.in', autoheader
needs to
build or to find templates for each symbol. Modern releases of Autoconf
use AH_VERBATIM
and AH_TEMPLATE
(see section 4.8.3 Autoheader Macros), but in older releases a file, `acconfig.h', contained the
list of needed templates. autoheader
copied comments and
#define
and #undef
statements from `acconfig.h' in
the current directory, if present. This file used to be mandatory if
you AC_DEFINE
any additional symbols.
Modern releases of Autoconf also provide AH_TOP
and
AH_BOTTOM
if you need to prepend/append some information to
`config.h.in'. Ancient versions of Autoconf had a similar feature:
if `./acconfig.h' contains the string `@TOP@',
autoheader
copies the lines before the line containing
`@TOP@' into the top of the file that it generates. Similarly,
if `./acconfig.h' contains the string `@BOTTOM@',
autoheader
copies the lines after that line to the end of the
file it generates. Either or both of those strings may be omitted. An
even older alternate way to produce the same effect in ancient versions
of Autoconf is to create the files `file.top' (typically
`config.h.top') and/or `file.bot' in the current
directory. If they exist, autoheader
copies them to the
beginning and end, respectively, of its output.
In former versions of Autoconf, the files used in preparing a software package for distribution were:
configure.ac --. .------> autoconf* -----> configure +---+ [aclocal.m4] --+ `---. [acsite.m4] ---' | +--> [autoheader*] -> [config.h.in] [acconfig.h] ----. | +-----' [config.h.top] --+ [config.h.bot] --' |
Using only the AH_
macros, `configure.ac' should be
self-contained, and should not depend upon `acconfig.h' etc.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
autoupdate
to Modernize `configure.ac'
The autoupdate
program updates a `configure.ac' file that
calls Autoconf macros by their old names to use the current macro names.
In version 2 of Autoconf, most of the macros were renamed to use a more
uniform and descriptive naming scheme. See section 9.2 Macro Names, for a
description of the new scheme. Although the old names still work
(see section 15.4 Obsolete Macros, for a list of the old macros and the corresponding
new names), you can make your `configure.ac' files more readable
and make it easier to use the current Autoconf documentation if you
update them to use the new macro names.
If given no arguments, autoupdate
updates `configure.ac',
backing up the original version with the suffix `~' (or the value
of the environment variable SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX
, if that is
set). If you give autoupdate
an argument, it reads that file
instead of `configure.ac' and writes the updated file to the
standard output.
autoupdate
accepts the following options:
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Several macros are obsoleted in Autoconf, for various reasons (typically they failed to quote properly, couldn't be extended for more recent issues etc.). They are still supported, but deprecated: their use should be avoided.
During the jump from Autoconf version 1 to version 2, most of the macros were renamed to use a more uniform and descriptive naming scheme, but their signature did not change. See section 9.2 Macro Names, for a description of the new naming scheme. Below, if there is just the mapping from old names to new names for these macros, the reader is invited to refer to the definition of the new macro for the signature and the description.
AC_FUNC_ALLOCA
The user is encouraged to use either AC_CANONICAL_BUILD
, or
AC_CANONICAL_HOST
, or AC_CANONICAL_TARGET
, depending on
the needs. Using AC_CANONICAL_TARGET
is enough to run the two
other macros.
AC_C_CHAR_UNSIGNED
AC_CHECK_TYPE
, deprecated because of its flaws. Firstly, although
it is a member of the CHECK
clan, singular sub-family, it does
more than just checking. Secondly, missing types are not
typedef
'd, they are #define
'd, which can lead to
incompatible code in the case of pointer types.
This use of AC_CHECK_TYPE
is obsolete and discouraged; see
5.9.2 Generic Type Checks, for the description of the current macro.
If the type type is not defined, define it to be the C (or C++) builtin type default, e.g., `short' or `unsigned'.
This macro is equivalent to:
AC_CHECK_TYPE([type],, [AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED([type], [default], [Define to `default' if <sys/types.h> does not define.])]) |
In order to keep backward compatibility, the two versions of
AC_CHECK_TYPE
are implemented, selected by a simple heuristics:
You are encouraged either to use a valid builtin type, or to use the
equivalent modern code (see above), or better yet, to use
AC_CHECK_TYPES
together with
#if !HAVE_LOFF_T typedef loff_t off_t; #endif |
AC_TRY_COMPILE
itself replaced by
AC_COMPILE_IFELSE
(see section 6.4 Running the Compiler), with the
addition that it prints `checking for echo-text' to the
standard output first, if echo-text is non-empty. Use
AC_MSG_CHECKING
and AC_MSG_RESULT
instead to print
messages (see section 7.4 Printing Messages).
AC_C_CONST
AC_C_CROSS
, which is obsolete too, and does nothing
:-)
.
CYGWIN
is set to `yes'. Don't use this macro, the dignified
means to check the nature of the host is using
AC_CANONICAL_HOST
. As a matter of fact this macro is defined as:
AC_REQUIRE([AC_CANONICAL_HOST])[]dnl case $host_os in *cygwin* ) CYGWIN=yes;; * ) CYGWIN=no;; esac |
Beware that the variable CYGWIN
has a very special meaning when
running CygWin32, and should not be changed. That's yet another reason
not to use this macro.
AC_PROG_LEX
.
AC_FUNC_CLOSEDIR_VOID
andAC_HEADER_DIRENT
,
but defines a different set of C preprocessor macros to indicate which
header file is found:
Header | Old Symbol | New Symbol |
`dirent.h' | DIRENT | HAVE_DIRENT_H |
`sys/ndir.h' | SYSNDIR | HAVE_SYS_NDIR_H |
`sys/dir.h' | SYSDIR | HAVE_SYS_DIR_H |
`ndir.h' | NDIR | HAVE_NDIR_H |
LIBS
. This macro used to be defined as
AC_CHECK_LIB(seq, getmntent, LIBS="-lseq $LIBS") |
now it is just AC_FUNC_GETMNTENT
.
EXEEXT
based on the output of the
compiler, which is now done automatically. Typically set to empty
string if Unix and `.exe' if Win32 or OS/2.
AC_CYGWIN
but checks for the EMX environment on OS/2
and sets EMXOS2
.
AC_MSG_ERROR
AC_PATH_X
AC_PATH_XTRA
AC_CHECK_FUNC
wait3
is found and fills in the contents of its third argument
(a `struct rusage *'), which HP-UX does not do, define
HAVE_WAIT3
.
These days portable programs should use waitpid
, not
wait3
, as wait3
is being removed from the Open Group
standards, and will not appear in the next revision of POSIX.
AC_PROG_GCC_TRADITIONAL
AC_TYPE_GETGROUPS
AC_FUNC_GETLOADAVG
AC_CHECK_FUNCS
AC_CHECK_HEADERS
AC_CHECK_LIB
with a
function argument of main
. In addition, library can
be written as any of `foo', `-lfoo', or `libfoo.a'. In
all of those cases, the compiler is passed `-lfoo'. However,
library cannot be a shell variable; it must be a literal name.
AC_SYS_INTERPRETER
(different calling convention)
AC_CHECK_HEADER
AC_EGREP_HEADER
AC_INIT
used to have a single argument, and was
equivalent to:
AC_INIT AC_CONFIG_SRCDIR(unique-file-in-source-dir) |
AC_C_INLINE
int
is 16 bits wide, define INT_16_BITS
.
Use `AC_CHECK_SIZEOF(int)' instead.
LIBS
. If you were using it to get getmntent
, use
AC_FUNC_GETMNTENT
instead. If you used it for the NIS versions
of the password and group functions, use `AC_CHECK_LIB(sun,
getpwnam)'. Up to Autoconf 2.13, it used to be
AC_CHECK_LIB(sun, getmntent, LIBS="-lsun $LIBS") |
now it is defined as
AC_FUNC_GETMNTENT AC_CHECK_LIB(sun, getpwnam) |
AC_LANG_SAVE
, remove it from the stack, and call
AC_LANG(language)
.
AC_LANG
) on a stack.
The current language does not change. AC_LANG_PUSH
is preferred.
AC_CONFIG_LINKS
. An updated
version of:
AC_LINK_FILES(config/$machine.h config/$obj_format.h, host.h object.h) |
is:
AC_CONFIG_LINKS(host.h:config/$machine.h object.h:config/$obj_format.h) |
AC_PROG_LN_S
LONG_64_BITS
if the C type long int
is 64 bits wide.
Use the generic macro `AC_CHECK_SIZEOF([long int])' instead.
AC_C_LONG_DOUBLE
AC_SYS_LONG_FILE_NAMES
AC_HEADER_MAJOR
NEED_MEMORY_H
if the mem
functions were
defined in `memory.h'. Today it is equivalent to
`AC_CHECK_HEADERS(memory.h)'. Adjust your code to depend upon
HAVE_MEMORY_H
, not NEED_MEMORY_H
; see 5.1.1 Standard Symbols.
AC_CYGWIN
but checks for the MingW32 compiler
environment and sets MINGW32
.
AC_PROG_CC_C_O
AC_FUNC_MMAP
AC_TYPE_MODE_T
OBJEXT
based on the output of the
compiler, after .c files have been excluded. Typically set to `o'
if Unix, `obj' if Win32. Now the compiler checking macros handle
this automatically.
AC_OBSOLETE
. If suggestion is given,
it is printed at the end of the warning message; for example, it can be
a suggestion for what to use instead of this-macro-name.
For instance
AC_OBSOLETE([$0], [; use AC_CHECK_HEADERS(unistd.h) instead])dnl |
You are encouraged to use AU_DEFUN
instead, since it gives better
services to the user.
AC_TYPE_OFF_T
AC_OUTPUT
with argument is deprecated. This obsoleted
interface is equivalent to:
AC_CONFIG_FILES(file...) AC_CONFIG_COMMANDS([default], extra-cmds, init-cmds) AC_OUTPUT |
configure
. This macro may be called multiple times. It is
obsolete, replaced by AC_CONFIG_COMMANDS
.
Here is an unrealistic example:
fubar=27 AC_OUTPUT_COMMANDS([echo this is extra $fubar, and so on.], [fubar=$fubar]) AC_OUTPUT_COMMANDS([echo this is another, extra, bit], [echo init bit]) |
Aside from the fact that AC_CONFIG_COMMANDS
requires an
additional key, an important difference is that
AC_OUTPUT_COMMANDS
is quoting its arguments twice, unlike
AC_CONFIG_COMMANDS
. This means that AC_CONFIG_COMMANDS
can safely be given macro calls as arguments:
AC_CONFIG_COMMANDS(foo, [my_FOO()]) |
Conversely, where one level of quoting was enough for literal strings
with AC_OUTPUT_COMMANDS
, you need two with
AC_CONFIG_COMMANDS
. The following lines are equivalent:
AC_OUTPUT_COMMANDS([echo "Square brackets: []"]) AC_CONFIG_COMMANDS([default], [[echo "Square brackets: []"]]) |
AC_TYPE_PID_T
AC_PREFIX_PROGRAM
AC_PROG_CC
.
AC_CHECK_PROGS
AC_PATH_PROGS
AC_CHECK_PROG
AC_EGREP_CPP
AC_PATH_PROG
AC_SYS_RESTARTABLE_SYSCALLS
AC_TYPE_SIGNAL
LIBS
. This
macro used to
AC_CHECK_LIB(intl, strftime, LIBS="-lintl $LIBS") |
Now it just calls AC_FUNC_STRFTIME
instead.
AC_FUNC_SETVBUF_REVERSED
AC_PROG_MAKE_SET
AC_CHECK_SIZEOF
AC_TYPE_SIZE_T
AC_HEADER_STAT
AC_HEADER_STDC
AC_FUNC_STRCOLL
AC_CHECK_MEMBERS
AC_STRUCT_ST_BLOCKS
AC_CHECK_MEMBERS
HAVE_RESTARTABLE_SYSCALLS
. This macro does
not check if system calls are restarted in general--it tests whether a
signal handler installed with signal
(but not sigaction
)
causes system calls to be restarted. It does not test if system calls
can be restarted when interrupted by signals that have no handler.
These days portable programs should use sigaction
with
SA_RESTART
if they want restartable system calls. They should
not rely on HAVE_RESTARTABLE_SYSCALLS
, since nowadays whether a
system call is restartable is a dynamic issue, not a configuration-time
issue.
AC_DECL_SYS_SIGLIST
AC_TRY_CPP
, replaced with AC_PREPROC_IFELSE
.
AC_TRY_RUN
, replaced with AC_RUN_IFELSE
.
AC_STRUCT_TIMEZONE
AC_HEADER_TIME
This macro double quotes both includes and function-body.
For C and C++, includes is any #include
statements needed
by the code in function-body (includes will be ignored if
the currently selected language is Fortran 77). This macro also uses
CFLAGS
or CXXFLAGS
if either C or C++ is the currently
selected language, as well as CPPFLAGS
, when compiling. If
Fortran 77 is the currently selected language then FFLAGS
will be
used when compiling.
This macro double quotes the input.
This macro double quotes both includes and function-body.
Depending on the current language (see section 6.1 Language Choice), create a test program to see whether a function whose body consists of function-body can be compiled and linked. If the file compiles and links successfully, run shell commands action-if-found, otherwise run action-if-not-found.
This macro double quotes both includes and function-body.
For C and C++, includes is any #include
statements needed
by the code in function-body (includes will be ignored if
the currently selected language is Fortran 77). This macro also uses
CFLAGS
or CXXFLAGS
if either C or C++ is the currently
selected language, as well as CPPFLAGS
, when compiling. If
Fortran 77 is the currently selected language then FFLAGS
will be
used when compiling. However, both LDFLAGS
and LIBS
will
be used during linking in all cases.
AC_TYPE_UID_T
USG
if the BSD string functions are defined in
`strings.h'. You should no longer depend upon USG
, but on
HAVE_STRING_H
; see 5.1.1 Standard Symbols.
AC_FUNC_UTIME_NULL
AC_MSG_RESULT
.
AC_FUNC_VFORK
AC_FUNC_VPRINTF
AC_FUNC_WAIT3
AC_MSG_WARN
AC_C_BIGENDIAN
LIBS
if on
Xenix. Also, if `dirent.h' is being checked for, added
`-ldir' to LIBS
. Now it is merely an alias of
AC_HEADER_DIRENT
instead, plus some code to detect whether
running XENIX on which you should not depend:
AC_MSG_CHECKING([for Xenix]) AC_EGREP_CPP(yes, [#if defined M_XENIX && !defined M_UNIX yes #endif], [AC_MSG_RESULT([yes]); XENIX=yes], [AC_MSG_RESULT([no]); XENIX=]) |
AC_DECL_YYTEXT
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Autoconf version 2 is mostly backward compatible with version 1.
However, it introduces better ways to do some things, and doesn't
support some of the ugly things in version 1. So, depending on how
sophisticated your `configure.ac' files are, you might have to do
some manual work in order to upgrade to version 2. This chapter points
out some problems to watch for when upgrading. Also, perhaps your
configure
scripts could benefit from some of the new features in
version 2; the changes are summarized in the file `NEWS' in the
Autoconf distribution.
15.5.1 Changed File Names Files you might rename 15.5.2 Changed Makefiles New things to put in `Makefile.in' 15.5.3 Changed Macros Macro calls you might replace 15.5.4 Changed Results Changes in how to check test results 15.5.5 Changed Macro Writing Better ways to write your own macros
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
If you have an `aclocal.m4' installed with Autoconf (as opposed to
in a particular package's source directory), you must rename it to
`acsite.m4'. See section 3.4 Using autoconf
to Create configure
.
If you distribute `install.sh' with your package, rename it to
`install-sh' so make
builtin rules won't inadvertently
create a file called `install' from it. AC_PROG_INSTALL
looks for the script under both names, but it is best to use the new name.
If you were using `config.h.top', `config.h.bot', or
`acconfig.h', you still can, but you will have less clutter if you
use the AH_
macros. See section 4.8.3 Autoheader Macros.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Add `@CFLAGS@', `@CPPFLAGS@', and `@LDFLAGS@' in
your `Makefile.in' files, so they can take advantage of the values
of those variables in the environment when configure
is run.
Doing this isn't necessary, but it's a convenience for users.
Also add `@configure_input@' in a comment to each input file for
AC_OUTPUT
, so that the output files will contain a comment saying
they were produced by configure
. Automatically selecting the
right comment syntax for all the kinds of files that people call
AC_OUTPUT
on became too much work.
Add `config.log' and `config.cache' to the list of files you
remove in distclean
targets.
If you have the following in `Makefile.in':
prefix = /usr/local exec_prefix = $(prefix) |
you must change it to:
prefix = @prefix@ exec_prefix = @exec_prefix@ |
The old behavior of replacing those variables without `@' characters around them has been removed.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Many of the macros were renamed in Autoconf version 2. You can still
use the old names, but the new ones are clearer, and it's easier to find
the documentation for them. See section 15.4 Obsolete Macros, for a table showing the
new names for the old macros. Use the autoupdate
program to
convert your `configure.ac' to using the new macro names.
See section 15.3 Using autoupdate
to Modernize `configure.ac'.
Some macros have been superseded by similar ones that do the job better,
but are not call-compatible. If you get warnings about calling obsolete
macros while running autoconf
, you may safely ignore them, but
your configure
script will generally work better if you follow
the advice that is printed about what to replace the obsolete macros with. In
particular, the mechanism for reporting the results of tests has
changed. If you were using echo
or AC_VERBOSE
(perhaps
via AC_COMPILE_CHECK
), your configure
script's output will
look better if you switch to AC_MSG_CHECKING
and
AC_MSG_RESULT
. See section 7.4 Printing Messages. Those macros work best
in conjunction with cache variables. See section 7.3 Caching Results.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
If you were checking the results of previous tests by examining the
shell variable DEFS
, you need to switch to checking the values of
the cache variables for those tests. DEFS
no longer exists while
configure
is running; it is only created when generating output
files. This difference from version 1 is because properly quoting the
contents of that variable turned out to be too cumbersome and
inefficient to do every time AC_DEFINE
is called. See section 7.3.1 Cache Variable Names.
For example, here is a `configure.ac' fragment written for Autoconf version 1:
AC_HAVE_FUNCS(syslog) case "$DEFS" in *-DHAVE_SYSLOG*) ;; *) # syslog is not in the default libraries. See if it's in some other. saved_LIBS="$LIBS" for lib in bsd socket inet; do AC_CHECKING(for syslog in -l$lib) LIBS="$saved_LIBS -l$lib" AC_HAVE_FUNCS(syslog) case "$DEFS" in *-DHAVE_SYSLOG*) break ;; *) ;; esac LIBS="$saved_LIBS" done ;; esac |
Here is a way to write it for version 2:
AC_CHECK_FUNCS(syslog) if test $ac_cv_func_syslog = no; then # syslog is not in the default libraries. See if it's in some other. for lib in bsd socket inet; do AC_CHECK_LIB($lib, syslog, [AC_DEFINE(HAVE_SYSLOG) LIBS="$LIBS -l$lib"; break]) done fi |
If you were working around bugs in AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED
by adding
backslashes before quotes, you need to remove them. It now works
predictably, and does not treat quotes (except back quotes) specially.
See section 7.2 Setting Output Variables.
All of the Boolean shell variables set by Autoconf macros now use `yes' for the true value. Most of them use `no' for false, though for backward compatibility some use the empty string instead. If you were relying on a shell variable being set to something like 1 or `t' for true, you need to change your tests.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
When defining your own macros, you should now use AC_DEFUN
instead of define
. AC_DEFUN
automatically calls
AC_PROVIDE
and ensures that macros called via AC_REQUIRE
do not interrupt other macros, to prevent nested `checking...'
messages on the screen. There's no actual harm in continuing to use the
older way, but it's less convenient and attractive. See section 9.1 Macro Definitions.
You probably looked at the macros that came with Autoconf as a guide for how to do things. It would be a good idea to take a look at the new versions of them, as the style is somewhat improved and they take advantage of some new features.
If you were doing tricky things with undocumented Autoconf internals (macros, variables, diversions), check whether you need to change anything to account for changes that have been made. Perhaps you can even use an officially supported technique in version 2 instead of kludging. Or perhaps not.
To speed up your locally written feature tests, add caching to them. See whether any of your tests are of general enough usefulness to encapsulate them into macros that you can share.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
The introduction of the previous section (see section 15.5 Upgrading From Version 1) perfectly suits this section....
Autoconf version 2.50 is mostly backward compatible with version 2.13.
However, it introduces better ways to do some things, and doesn't
support some of the ugly things in version 2.13. So, depending on how
sophisticated your `configure.ac' files are, you might have to do
some manual work in order to upgrade to version 2.50. This chapter
points out some problems to watch for when upgrading. Also, perhaps
your configure
scripts could benefit from some of the new
features in version 2.50; the changes are summarized in the file
`NEWS' in the Autoconf distribution.
15.6.1 Changed Quotation Broken code which used to work 15.6.2 New Macros Interaction with foreign macros 15.6.3 Hosts and Cross-Compilation Bugward compatibility kludges 15.6.4 AC_LIBOBJ
vs.LIBOBJS
LIBOBJS is a forbidden token 15.6.5 AC_FOO_IFELSE
vs.AC_TRY_FOO
A more generic scheme for testing sources
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
The most important changes are invisible to you: the implementation of most macros have completely changed. This allowed more factorization of the code, better error messages, a higher uniformity of the user's interface etc. Unfortunately, as a side effect, some construct which used to (miraculously) work might break starting with Autoconf 2.50. The most common culprit is bad quotation.
For instance, in the following example, the message is not properly quoted:
AC_INIT AC_CHECK_HEADERS(foo.h,, AC_MSG_ERROR(cannot find foo.h, bailing out)) AC_OUTPUT |
Autoconf 2.13 simply ignores it:
$ autoconf-2.13; ./configure --silent creating cache ./config.cache configure: error: cannot find foo.h $ |
while Autoconf 2.50 will produce a broken `configure':
$ autoconf-2.50; ./configure --silent configure: error: cannot find foo.h ./configure: exit: bad non-numeric arg `bailing' ./configure: exit: bad non-numeric arg `bailing' $ |
The message needs to be quoted, and the AC_MSG_ERROR
invocation
too!
AC_INIT AC_CHECK_HEADERS(foo.h,, [AC_MSG_ERROR([cannot find foo.h, bailing out])]) AC_OUTPUT |
Many many (and many more) Autoconf macros were lacking proper quotation,
including no less than... AC_DEFUN
itself!
$ cat configure.in AC_DEFUN([AC_PROG_INSTALL], [# My own much better version ]) AC_INIT AC_PROG_INSTALL AC_OUTPUT $ autoconf-2.13 autoconf: Undefined macros: ***BUG in Autoconf--please report*** AC_FD_MSG ***BUG in Autoconf--please report*** AC_EPI configure.in:1:AC_DEFUN([AC_PROG_INSTALL], configure.in:5:AC_PROG_INSTALL $ autoconf-2.50 $ |
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Because Autoconf has been dormant for years, Automake provided
Autoconf-like macros for a while. Autoconf 2.50 now provides better
versions of these macros, integrated in the AC_
namespace,
instead of AM_
. But in order to ease the upgrading via
autoupdate
, bindings to such AM_
macros are provided.
Unfortunately Automake did not quote the names of these macros!
Therefore, when m4
finds something like
`AC_DEFUN(AM_TYPE_PTRDIFF_T, ...)' in `aclocal.m4',
AM_TYPE_PTRDIFF_T
is
expanded, replaced with its Autoconf definition.
Fortunately Autoconf catches pre-AC_INIT
expansions, and will
complain, in its own words:
$ cat configure.in AC_INIT AM_TYPE_PTRDIFF_T $ aclocal-1.4 $ autoconf ./aclocal.m4:17: error: m4_defn: undefined macro: _m4_divert_diversion actypes.m4:289: AM_TYPE_PTRDIFF_T is expanded from... ./aclocal.m4:17: the top level $ |
Future versions of Automake will simply no longer define most of these macros, and will properly quote the names of the remaining macros. But you don't have to wait for it to happen to do the right thing right now: do not depend upon macros from Automake as it is simply not its job to provide macros (but the one it requires itself):
$ cat configure.in AC_INIT AM_TYPE_PTRDIFF_T $ rm aclocal.m4 $ autoupdate autoupdate: `configure.in' is updated $ cat configure.in AC_INIT AC_CHECK_TYPES([ptrdiff_t]) $ aclocal-1.4 $ autoconf $ |
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Based on the experience of compiler writers, and after long public debates, many aspects of the cross-compilation chain have changed:
configure
,
configure
,
The relationship between build, host, and target have been cleaned up:
the chain of default is now simply: target defaults to host, host to
build, and build to the result of config.guess
. Nevertheless,
in order to ease the transition from 2.13 to 2.50, the following
transition scheme is implemented. Do not rely on it, as it will
be completely disabled in a couple of releases (we cannot keep it, as it
proves to cause more problems than it cures).
They all default to the result of running config.guess
, unless
you specify either `--build' or `--host'. In this case,
the default becomes the system type you specified. If you specify both,
and they're different, configure
will enter cross compilation
mode, so it won't run any tests that require execution.
Hint: if you mean to override the result of config.guess
,
prefer `--build' over `--host'. In the future,
`--host' will not override the name of the build system type.
Whenever you specify --host
, be sure to specify --build
too.
For backward compatibility, configure
will accept a system
type as an option by itself. Such an option will override the
defaults for build, host, and target system types. The following
configure statement will configure a cross toolchain that will run on
NetBSD/alpha but generate code for GNU Hurd/sparc, which is
also the build platform.
./configure --host=alpha-netbsd sparc-gnu |
In Autoconf 2.13 and before, the variables build
, host
,
and target
had a different semantics before and after the
invocation of AC_CANONICAL_BUILD
etc. Now, the argument of
`--build' is strictly copied into build_alias
, and is left
empty otherwise. After the AC_CANONICAL_BUILD
, build
is
set to the canonicalized build type. To ease the transition, before,
its contents is the same as that of build_alias
. Do not
rely on this broken feature.
For consistency with the backward compatibility scheme exposed above, when `--host' is specified but `--build' isn't, the build system will be assumed to be the same as `--host', and `build_alias' will be set to that value. Eventually, this historically incorrect behavior will go away.
The former scheme to enable cross-compilation proved to cause more harm
than good, in particular, it used to be triggered too easily, leaving
regular end users puzzled in front of cryptic error messages.
configure
could even enter cross-compilation mode only
because the compiler was not functional. This is mainly because
configure
used to try to detect cross-compilation, instead of
waiting for an explicit flag from the user.
Now, configure
enters cross-compilation mode if and only if
`--host' is passed.
That's the short documentation. To ease the transition between 2.13 and its successors, a more complicated scheme is implemented. Do not rely on the following, as it will be removed in the near future.
If you specify `--host', but not `--build', when
configure
performs the first compiler test it will try to run
an executable produced by the compiler. If the execution fails, it will
enter cross-compilation mode. This is fragile. Moreover, by the time
the compiler test is performed, it may be too late to modify the
build-system type: other tests may have already been performed.
Therefore, whenever you specify --host
, be sure to specify
--build
too.
./configure --build=i686-pc-linux-gnu --host=m68k-coff |
will enter cross-compilation mode. The former interface, which
consisted in setting the compiler to a cross-compiler without informing
configure
is obsolete. For instance, configure
will
fail if it can't run the code generated by the specified compiler if you
configure as follows:
./configure CC=m68k-coff-gcc |
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
AC_LIBOBJ
vs. LIBOBJS
Up to Autoconf 2.13, the replacement of functions was triggered via the
variable LIBOBJS
. Since Autoconf 2.50, the macro
AC_LIBOBJ
should be used instead (see section 5.5.3 Generic Function Checks).
Starting at Autoconf 2.53, the use of LIBOBJS
is an error.
This change is mandated by the unification of the GNU Build System
components. In particular, the various fragile techniques used to parse
a `configure.ac' are all replaced with the use of traces. As a
consequence, any action must be traceable, which obsoletes critical
variable assignments. Fortunately, LIBOBJS
was the only problem,
and it can even be handled gracefully (read, "without your having to
change something").
There were two typical uses of LIBOBJS
: asking for a replacement
function, and adjusting LIBOBJS
for Automake and/or Libtool.
As for function replacement, the fix is immediate: use
AC_LIBOBJ
. For instance:
LIBOBJS="$LIBOBJS fnmatch.o" LIBOBJS="$LIBOBJS malloc.$ac_objext" |
should be replaced with:
AC_LIBOBJ([fnmatch]) AC_LIBOBJ([malloc]) |
When asked for automatic de-ANSI-fication, Automake needs
LIBOBJS
'ed filenames to have `$U' appended to the base
names. Libtool requires the definition of LTLIBOBJS
, whose
suffixes are mapped to `.lo'. People used to run snippets such as:
# This is necessary so that .o files in LIBOBJS are also built via # the ANSI2KNR-filtering rules. LIBOBJS=`echo "$LIBOBJS" | sed 's/\.o /\$U.o /g;s/\.o$/\$U.o/'` LTLIBOBJS=`echo "$LIBOBJS" | sed 's/\.o/\.lo/g'` AC_SUBST(LTLIBOBJS) |
Note that this code is wrong, because `.o' is not the only possible extension(4)! It should have read:
# This is necessary so that .o files in LIBOBJS are also built via # the ANSI2KNR-filtering rules. LIB@&t@OBJS=`echo "$LIB@&t@OBJS" | sed 's,\.[[^.]]* ,$U&,g;s,\.[[^.]]*$,$U&,'` LTLIBOBJS=`echo "$LIB@&t@OBJS" | sed 's,\.[[^.]]* ,.lo ,g;s,\.[[^.]]*$,.lo,'` AC_SUBST(LTLIBOBJS) |
You no longer have to use this: AC_OUTPUT
normalizes
LIBOBJS
and LTLIBOBJS
(hence it works with any version of
Automake and Libtool). Just remove these lines (autoupdate
cannot handle this task, since this is not a macro).
Note that U
must not be used in your Makefiles.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
AC_FOO_IFELSE
vs. AC_TRY_FOO
Since Autoconf 2.50, internal codes uses AC_PREPROC_IFELSE
,
AC_COMPILE_IFELSE
, AC_LINK_IFELSE
, and
AC_RUN_IFELSE
on the other one hand and AC_LANG_SOURCES
,
and AC_LANG_PROGRAM
on the other hand instead of the deprecated
AC_TRY_CPP
, AC_TRY_COMPILE
, AC_TRY_LINK
, and
AC_TRY_RUN
. The motivations where:
AC_TRY_COMPILE
etc. were double
quoting their arguments;
In addition to the change of syntax, the philosphy has changed too: while emphasis was put on speed at the expense of accuracy, today's Autoconf promotes accuracy of the testing framework at, ahem..., the expense of speed.
As a perfect example of what is not to be done, here is how to
find out whether a header file contains a particular declaration, such
as a typedef, a structure, a structure member, or a function. Use
AC_EGREP_HEADER
instead of running grep
directly on the
header file; on some systems the symbol might be defined in another
header file that the file you are checking `#include's.
As a (bad) example, here is how you should not check for C preprocessor
symbols, either defined by header files or predefined by the C
preprocessor: using AC_EGREP_CPP
:
AC_EGREP_CPP(yes, [#ifdef _AIX yes #endif ], is_aix=yes, is_aix=no) |
The above example, properly written would (i) use
AC_LANG_PROGRAM
, and (ii) run the compiler:
AC_COMPILE_IFELSE([AC_LANG_PROGRAM( [[#if !defined _AIX # error _AIX not defined #endif ]])], [is_aix=yes], [is_aix=no]) |
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Note: This section describes an experimental feature which will be part of Autoconf in a forthcoming release. Although we believe Autotest is stabilizing, this documentation describes an interface which might change in the future: do not depend upon Autotest without subscribing to the Autoconf mailing lists. |
It is paradoxical that portable projects depend on nonportable tools to run their test suite. Autoconf by itself is the paragon of this problem: although it aims at perfectly portability, up to 2.13, its test suite was using DejaGNU, a rich and complex testing framework, but which is far from being standard on Unix systems. Worse yet, it was likely to be missing on the most fragile platforms, the very platforms that are most likely to torture Autoconf and exhibit deficiencies.
To circumvent this problem many package maintainers have developed their own testing framework, based on simple shell scripts whose sole output are their exit status: the test succeeded, or failed. In addition, most of these tests share some common patterns, what results in lots of duplicated code, tedious maintenance etc.
Following exactly the same reasoning that yielded to the inception of Autoconf, Autotest provides a test suite generation frame work, based on M4 macros, building a portable shell script. The suite itself is equipped with automatic logging and tracing facilities which greatly diminish the interaction with bug reporters, and simple timing reports.
Autoconf itself has been using Autotest for years, and we do attest that it has considerably improved the strength of the test suite, and the quality of bug reports. Other projects are known to use some generation of Autotest, such as Bison, Free Recode, Free Wdiff, GNU Tar, each of them having different needs, what slowly polishes Autotest as a general testing framework.
Nonetheless, compared to DejaGNU, Autotest is inadequate for interactive tool testing, which is probably its main limitation.
16.1 Using an Autotest Test Suite Autotest and the user 16.2 Writing `testsuite.at' Autotest macros 16.3 Running testsuite
ScriptsRunning testsuite
scripts16.4 Making testsuite
ScriptsUsing autom4te to create testsuite
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
16.1.1 testsuite
ScriptsThe concepts of Autotest 16.1.2 Autotest Logs Their contents
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
testsuite
Scripts
Generating testing or validation suites using Autotest is rather easy.
The whole validation suite is held in a file to be processed through
autom4te
, itself using GNU M4 under the scene, to
produce a stand-alone Bourne shell script which then gets distributed.
Neither autom4te
nor GNU M4 are not needed anymore at
the installer end.
Each test of the validation suite should be part of some test group. A test group is a sequence of interwoven tests that ought to be executed together, usually because one test in the group creates data files than a later test in the same group needs to read. Complex test groups make later debugging more tedious. It is much better keeping keep only a few tests per test group, and if you can put only one test per test group, this is just ideal.
For all but the simplest packages, some file such as `testsuite.at' does not fully hold all test sources, as these are often easier to maintain in separate files. Each of these separate files holds a single test group, or a sequence of test groups all addressing some common functionality in the package. In such cases, file `testsuite.at' only initializes the whole validation suite, and sometimes do elementary health checking, before listing include statements for all other test files. The special file `package.m4', containing the identification of the package, is automatically included if found.
The validation scripts that Autotest produces are by convention called
testsuite
. When run, testsuite
executes each test
group in turn, producing only one summary line per test to say if that
particular test succeeded or failed. At end of all tests, summarizing
counters get printed. If any test failed, one debugging script gets
automatically generated for each test group which failed. These
debugging scripts are named `testsuite.nn', where nn is
the sequence number of the test group. In the ideal situation, none of
the tests fail, and consequently, no debugging script is generated out
of validation.
The automatic generation of debugging scripts for failed test has the purpose of easing the chase for bugs.
It often happens in practice that individual tests in the validation
suite need to get information coming out of the configuration process.
Some of this information, common for all validation suites, is provided
through the file `atconfig', automatically created by
AC_CONFIG_TESTDIR
. For configuration informations which your
testing environment specifically needs, you might prepare an optional
file named `atlocal.in', instantiated by AC_CONFIG_FILES
.
The configuration process produces `atconfig' and `atlocal'
out of these two input files, and these two produced files are
automatically read by the `testsuite' script.
Here is a diagram showing the relationship between files.
Files used in preparing a software package for distribution:
subfile-1.at ->. ... \ subfile-i.at ---->-- testsuite.at -->. ... / \ subfile-n.at ->' >-- autom4te* -->testsuite / [package.m4] ->' |
Files used in configuring a software package:
.--> atconfig / [atlocal.in] --> config.status* --< \ `--> [atlocal] |
Files created during the test suite execution:
atconfig -->. .--> testsuite.log \ / >-- testsuite* --< / \ [atlocal] ->' `--> [testsuite.nn*] |
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
When run, the test suite creates a log file named after itself, e.g., a
test suite named testsuite
creates `testsuite.log'. It
contains a lot of information, usually more than maintainers actually
need, but therefore most of the time it contains all that is needed:
CC
for subsequent runs(5). Autoconf faced exactly the same problem, and solved it by asking
users to pass the variable definitions as command line arguments.
Autotest requires this rule too, but has no means to enforce it; the log
then contains a trace of the variables the user changed.
AT_TESTED
).
configure
,
are appended. It contains the configuration flags and a detailed report
on the configuration itself.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
The `testsuite.at' is a Bourne shell script making use of special
Autotest M4 macros. It often contains a call to AT_INIT
nears
its beginning followed by one call to m4_include
per source file
for tests. Each such included file, or the remainder of
`testsuite.at' if include files are not used, contain a sequence of
test groups. Each test group begins with one call to AT_SETUP
,
it contains an arbitrary number of shell commands or calls to
AT_CHECK
, and it completes with one call to AT_CLEANUP
.
Autotest test suites rely on the PATH
to find the tested program.
This saves from generating the absolute paths to the various tools, and
makes it possible to test installed programs. Therefore, knowing what
programs are being exercised is crucial to understand some problems in
the test suite itself, or its occasional misuses. It is a good idea to
also subscribe foreign programs you depend upon, to ease incompatibility
diagnostics.
AT_KEYWORDS
.
Several invocations within a test group accumulate new keywords. In other words, don't fear registering several times the same keyword in a test group.
The commands must not redirect the standard output, nor the standard error.
If status, or stdout, or stderr is `ignore', then the corresponding value is not checked.
The special value `expout' for stdout means the expected output of the commands is the content of the file `expout'. If stdout is `stdout', then the standard output of the commands is available for further tests in the file `stdout'. Similarly for stderr with `expout' and `stderr'.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
testsuite
Scripts Autotest test suites support the following arguments:
clean
Makefile targets.
By default all the tests are performed (or described with `--list') in the default environment first silently, then verbosely, but the environment, set of tests, and verbosity level can be tuned:
The variable AUTOTEST_PATH
specifies the testing path to prepend
to PATH
. It handles specially relative paths (not starting with
`/'): they are considered to be relative to the top level of the
package being built. All the directories are made absolute, first
starting from the top level build tree, then from the
source tree. For instance `./testsuite
AUTOTEST_PATH=tests:bin' for a `/src/foo-1.0' source package built
in `/tmp/foo' results in `/tmp/foo/tests:/tmp/foo/bin' and
then `/src/foo-1.0/tests:/src/foo-1.0/bin' being prepended to
PATH
.
AT_SETUP
or AT_KEYWORDS
) match all the keywords
of the comma separated list keywords.
Running `./testsuite -k autoupdate,FUNC' will select all the tests tagged with `autoupdate' and `FUNC' (as in `AC_CHECK_FUNC', `AC_FUNC_FNMATCH' etc.) while `./testsuite -k autoupdate -k FUNC' runs all the tests tagged with `autoupdate' or `FUNC'.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
testsuite
Scripts For putting Autotest into movement, you need some configuration and Makefile machinery. We recommend, at least if your package uses deep or shallow hierarchies, that you use `tests/' as the name of the directory holding all your tests and their `Makefile'. Here is a check list of things to do.
AT_PACKAGE_STRING
, the
full signature of the package, and AT_PACKAGE_BUGREPORT
, the
address to which bug reports should be sent. For sake of completeness,
we suggest that you also define AT_PACKAGE_NAME
,
AT_PACKAGE_TARNAME
, and AT_PACKAGE_VERSION
.
See section 4.1 Initializing configure
, for a description of these variables. We
suggest the following Makefile excerpt:
$(srcdir)/package.m4: $(top_srcdir)/configure.ac { \ echo '# Signature of the current package.'; \ echo 'm4_define([AT_PACKAGE_NAME], [@PACKAGE_NAME@])'; \ echo 'm4_define([AT_PACKAGE_TARNAME], [@PACKAGE_TARNAME@])'; \ echo 'm4_define([AT_PACKAGE_VERSION], [@PACKAGE_VERSION@])'; \ echo 'm4_define([AT_PACKAGE_STRING], [@PACKAGE_STRING@])'; \ echo 'm4_define([AT_PACKAGE_BUGREPORT], [@PACKAGE_BUGREPORT@])'; \ } >$(srcdir)/package.m4 |
Be sure to distribute `package.m4' and to put it into the source hierarchy: the test suite ought to be shipped!
AC_CONFIG_TESTDIR
.
AUTOTEST_PATH
to test-path (see section 16.3 Running testsuite
Scripts).
AC_CONFIG_FILES
command includes substitution for
`tests/atlocal'.
With Automake, here is a minimal example about how to link `make check' with a validation suite.
EXTRA_DIST = testsuite.at testsuite TESTSUITE = $(srcdir)/testsuite check-local: atconfig atlocal $(TESTSUITE) $(SHELL) $(TESTSUITE) AUTOTEST = $(AUTOM4TE) --language=autotest $(TESTSUITE): $(srcdir)/testsuite.at $(AUTOTEST) -I $(srcdir) $@.at -o $@.tmp mv $@.tmp $@ |
You might want to list explicitly the dependencies, i.e., the list of the files `testsuite.at' includes.
With strict Autoconf, you might need to add lines inspired from the following:
subdir = tests atconfig: $(top_builddir)/config.status cd $(top_builddir) && \ $(SHELL) ./config.status $(subdir)/$@ atlocal: $(srcdir)/atlocal.in $(top_builddir)/config.status cd $(top_builddir) && \ $(SHELL) ./config.status $(subdir)/$@ |
and manage to have `atconfig.in' and $(EXTRA_DIST)
distributed.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Several questions about Autoconf come up occasionally. Here some of them are addressed.
17.1 Distributing configure
ScriptsDistributing configure
scripts17.2 Why Require GNU M4? Why not use the standard M4? 17.3 How Can I Bootstrap? Autoconf and GNU M4 require each other? 17.4 Why Not Imake? Why GNU uses configure
instead of Imake17.5 How Do I #define
Installation Directories?Passing datadir
to program17.6 What is `autom4te.cache'? What is it? Can I remove it?
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
configure
Scripts
What are the restrictions on distributing |
There are no restrictions on how the configuration scripts that Autoconf produces may be distributed or used. In Autoconf version 1, they were covered by the GNU General Public License. We still encourage software authors to distribute their work under terms like those of the GPL, but doing so is not required to use Autoconf.
Of the other files that might be used with configure
,
`config.h.in' is under whatever copyright you use for your
`configure.ac'. `config.sub' and `config.guess' have an
exception to the GPL when they are used with an Autoconf-generated
configure
script, which permits you to distribute them under the
same terms as the rest of your package. `install-sh' is from the X
Consortium and is not copyrighted.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Why does Autoconf require GNU M4? |
Many M4 implementations have hard-coded limitations on the size and number of macros that Autoconf exceeds. They also lack several builtin macros that it would be difficult to get along without in a sophisticated application like Autoconf, including:
m4_builtin m4_indir m4_bpatsubst __file__ __line__ |
Autoconf requires version 1.4 or above of GNU M4 because it uses frozen state files.
Since only software maintainers need to use Autoconf, and since GNU M4 is simple to configure and install, it seems reasonable to require GNU M4 to be installed also. Many maintainers of GNU and other free software already have most of the GNU utilities installed, since they prefer them.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
If Autoconf requires GNU M4 and GNU M4 has an Autoconf
|
This is a misunderstanding. Although GNU M4 does come with a
configure
script produced by Autoconf, Autoconf is not required
in order to run the script and install GNU M4. Autoconf is only
required if you want to change the M4 configure
script, which few
people have to do (mainly its maintainer).
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Why not use Imake instead of |
Several people have written addressing this question, so I include adaptations of their explanations here.
The following answer is based on one written by Richard Pixley:
Autoconf generated scripts frequently work on machines that it has never been set up to handle before. That is, it does a good job of inferring a configuration for a new system. Imake cannot do this.Imake uses a common database of host specific data. For X11, this makes sense because the distribution is made as a collection of tools, by one central authority who has control over the database.
GNU tools are not released this way. Each GNU tool has a maintainer; these maintainers are scattered across the world. Using a common database would be a maintenance nightmare. Autoconf may appear to be this kind of database, but in fact it is not. Instead of listing host dependencies, it lists program requirements.
If you view the GNU suite as a collection of native tools, then the problems are similar. But the GNU development tools can be configured as cross tools in almost any host+target permutation. All of these configurations can be installed concurrently. They can even be configured to share host independent files across hosts. Imake doesn't address these issues.
Imake templates are a form of standardization. The GNU coding standards address the same issues without necessarily imposing the same restrictions.
Here is some further explanation, written by Per Bothner:
One of the advantages of Imake is that it easy to generate large Makefiles usingcpp
's `#include' and macro mechanisms. However,cpp
is not programmable: it has limited conditional facilities, and no looping. Andcpp
cannot inspect its environment.All of these problems are solved by using
sh
instead ofcpp
. The shell is fully programmable, has macro substitution, can execute (or source) other shell scripts, and can inspect its environment.
Paul Eggert elaborates more:
With Autoconf, installers need not assume that Imake itself is already installed and working well. This may not seem like much of an advantage to people who are accustomed to Imake. But on many hosts Imake is not installed or the default installation is not working well, and requiring Imake to install a package hinders the acceptance of that package on those hosts. For example, the Imake template and configuration files might not be installed properly on a host, or the Imake build procedure might wrongly assume that all source files are in one big directory tree, or the Imake configuration might assume one compiler whereas the package or the installer needs to use another, or there might be a version mismatch between the Imake expected by the package and the Imake supported by the host. These problems are much rarer with Autoconf, where each package comes with its own independent configuration processor.Also, Imake often suffers from unexpected interactions between
make
and the installer's C preprocessor. The fundamental problem here is that the C preprocessor was designed to preprocess C programs, not `Makefile's. This is much less of a problem with Autoconf, which uses the general-purpose preprocessor M4, and where the package's author (rather than the installer) does the preprocessing in a standard way.
Finally, Mark Eichin notes:
Imake isn't all that extensible, either. In order to add new features to Imake, you need to provide your own project template, and duplicate most of the features of the existing one. This means that for a sophisticated project, using the vendor-provided Imake templates fails to provide any leverage--since they don't cover anything that your own project needs (unless it is an X11 program).On the other side, though:
The one advantage that Imake has over
configure
: `Imakefile's tend to be much shorter (likewise, less redundant) than `Makefile.in's. There is a fix to this, however--at least for the Kerberos V5 tree, we've modified things to call in common `post.in' and `pre.in' `Makefile' fragments for the entire tree. This means that a lot of common things don't have to be duplicated, even though they normally are inconfigure
setups.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
#define
Installation Directories?
My program needs library files, installed in
I get
|
As already explained, this behavior is on purpose, mandated by the GNU Coding Standards, see 4.7.2 Installation Directory Variables. There are several means to achieve a similar goal:
AC_DEFINE
but use your `Makefile' to pass the
actual value of datadir
via compilation flags, see
4.7.2 Installation Directory Variables, for the details.
CPPFLAGS
:
CPPFLAGS = -DDATADIR=\"$(datadir)\" @CPPFLAGS@ |
or create a dedicated header file:
DISTCLEANFILES = datadir.h datadir.h: Makefile echo '#define DATADIR "$(datadir)"' >$@ |
AC_DEFINE
but have configure
compute the literal
value of datadir
and others. Many people have wrapped macros to
automate this task. For instance, the macro AC_DEFINE_DIR
from
the Autoconf Macro Archive.
This solution does not conform to the GNU Coding Standards.
prefix
, and try to
find prefix
at runtime, this way your package is relocatable.
Some macros are already available to address this issue: see
adl_COMPUTE_RELATIVE_PATHS
and
adl_COMPUTE_STANDARD_RELATIVE_PATHS
on the
Autoconf Macro Archive.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
What is this directory `autom4te.cache'? Can I safely remove it? |
In the GNU Build System, `configure.ac' plays a central
role and is read by many tools: autoconf
to create
`configure', autoheader
to create `config.h.in',
automake
to create `Makefile.in', autoscan
to
check the completeness of `configure.ac', autoreconf
to
check the GNU Build System components that are used. To
"read `configure.ac'" actually means to compile it with M4,
which can be a very long process for complex `configure.ac'.
This is why all these tools, instead of running directly M4, invoke
autom4te
(see section 8.2.1 Invoking autom4te
) which, while answering to
a specific demand, stores additional information in
`autom4te.cache' for future runs. For instance, if you run
autoconf
, behind the scenes, autom4te
will also
store information for the other tools, so that when you invoke
autoheader
or automake
etc., re-processing
`configure.ac' is not needed. The speed up is frequently of 30,
and is increasing with the size of `configure.ac'.
But it is and remains being simply a cache: you can safely remove it.
Can I permanently get rid of it? |
The creation of this cache can be disabled from
`~/.autom4te.cfg', see 8.2.2 Customizing autom4te
, for more
details. You should be aware that disabling the cache slows down the
Autoconf test suite by 40%. The more GNU Build System
components are used, the more the cache is useful; for instance
running `autoreconf -f' on the Coreutils is twice slower without
the cache although `--force' implies that the cache is
not fully exploited, and eight times slower than without
`--force'.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
You may be wondering, Why was Autoconf originally written? How did it get into its present form? (Why does it look like gorilla spit?) If you're not wondering, then this chapter contains no information useful to you, and you might as well skip it. If you are wondering, then let there be light....
18.1 Genesis Prehistory and naming of configure
18.2 Exodus The plagues of M4 and Perl 18.3 Leviticus The priestly code of portability arrives 18.4 Numbers Growth and contributors 18.5 Deuteronomy Approaching the promises of easy configuration
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
In June 1991 I was maintaining many of the GNU utilities for the
Free Software Foundation. As they were ported to more platforms and
more programs were added, the number of `-D' options that users
had to select in the `Makefile' (around 20) became burdensome.
Especially for me--I had to test each new release on a bunch of
different systems. So I wrote a little shell script to guess some of
the correct settings for the fileutils package, and released it as part
of fileutils 2.0. That configure
script worked well enough that
the next month I adapted it (by hand) to create similar configure
scripts for several other GNU utilities packages. Brian Berliner
also adapted one of my scripts for his CVS revision control system.
Later that summer, I learned that Richard Stallman and Richard Pixley
were developing similar scripts to use in the GNU compiler tools;
so I adapted my configure
scripts to support their evolving
interface: using the file name `Makefile.in' as the templates;
adding `+srcdir', the first option (of many); and creating
`config.status' files.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
As I got feedback from users, I incorporated many improvements, using
Emacs to search and replace, cut and paste, similar changes in each of
the scripts. As I adapted more GNU utilities packages to use
configure
scripts, updating them all by hand became impractical.
Rich Murphey, the maintainer of the GNU graphics utilities, sent me
mail saying that the configure
scripts were great, and asking if
I had a tool for generating them that I could send him. No, I thought,
but I should! So I started to work out how to generate them. And the
journey from the slavery of hand-written configure
scripts to the
abundance and ease of Autoconf began.
Cygnus configure
, which was being developed at around that time,
is table driven; it is meant to deal mainly with a discrete number of
system types with a small number of mainly unguessable features (such as
details of the object file format). The automatic configuration system
that Brian Fox had developed for Bash takes a similar approach. For
general use, it seems to me a hopeless cause to try to maintain an
up-to-date database of which features each variant of each operating
system has. It's easier and more reliable to check for most features on
the fly--especially on hybrid systems that people have hacked on
locally or that have patches from vendors installed.
I considered using an architecture similar to that of Cygnus
configure
, where there is a single configure
script that
reads pieces of `configure.in' when run. But I didn't want to have
to distribute all of the feature tests with every package, so I settled
on having a different configure
made from each
`configure.in' by a preprocessor. That approach also offered more
control and flexibility.
I looked briefly into using the Metaconfig package, by Larry Wall,
Harlan Stenn, and Raphael Manfredi, but I decided not to for several
reasons. The Configure
scripts it produces are interactive,
which I find quite inconvenient; I didn't like the ways it checked for
some features (such as library functions); I didn't know that it was
still being maintained, and the Configure
scripts I had
seen didn't work on many modern systems (such as System V R4 and NeXT);
it wasn't very flexible in what it could do in response to a feature's
presence or absence; I found it confusing to learn; and it was too big
and complex for my needs (I didn't realize then how much Autoconf would
eventually have to grow).
I considered using Perl to generate my style of configure
scripts, but decided that M4 was better suited to the job of simple
textual substitutions: it gets in the way less, because output is
implicit. Plus, everyone already has it. (Initially I didn't rely on
the GNU extensions to M4.) Also, some of my friends at the
University of Maryland had recently been putting M4 front ends on
several programs, including tvtwm
, and I was interested in trying
out a new language.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Since my configure
scripts determine the system's capabilities
automatically, with no interactive user intervention, I decided to call
the program that generates them Autoconfig. But with a version number
tacked on, that name would be too long for old UNIX file systems,
so I shortened it to Autoconf.
In the fall of 1991 I called together a group of fellow questers after the Holy Grail of portability (er, that is, alpha testers) to give me feedback as I encapsulated pieces of my handwritten scripts in M4 macros and continued to add features and improve the techniques used in the checks. Prominent among the testers were Fran@,cois Pinard, who came up with the idea of making an Autoconf shell script to run M4 and check for unresolved macro calls; Richard Pixley, who suggested running the compiler instead of searching the file system to find include files and symbols, for more accurate results; Karl Berry, who got Autoconf to configure TeX and added the macro index to the documentation; and Ian Lance Taylor, who added support for creating a C header file as an alternative to putting `-D' options in a `Makefile', so he could use Autoconf for his UUCP package. The alpha testers cheerfully adjusted their files again and again as the names and calling conventions of the Autoconf macros changed from release to release. They all contributed many specific checks, great ideas, and bug fixes.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
In July 1992, after months of alpha testing, I released Autoconf 1.0,
and converted many GNU packages to use it. I was surprised by how
positive the reaction to it was. More people started using it than I
could keep track of, including people working on software that wasn't
part of the GNU Project (such as TCL, FSP, and Kerberos V5).
Autoconf continued to improve rapidly, as many people using the
configure
scripts reported problems they encountered.
Autoconf turned out to be a good torture test for M4 implementations. UNIX M4 started to dump core because of the length of the macros that Autoconf defined, and several bugs showed up in GNU M4 as well. Eventually, we realized that we needed to use some features that only GNU M4 has. 4.3BSD M4, in particular, has an impoverished set of builtin macros; the System V version is better, but still doesn't provide everything we need.
More development occurred as people put Autoconf under more stresses
(and to uses I hadn't anticipated). Karl Berry added checks for X11.
david zuhn contributed C++ support. Fran@,cois Pinard made it diagnose
invalid arguments. Jim Blandy bravely coerced it into configuring
GNU Emacs, laying the groundwork for several later improvements.
Roland McGrath got it to configure the GNU C Library, wrote the
autoheader
script to automate the creation of C header file
templates, and added a `--verbose' option to configure
.
Noah Friedman added the `--autoconf-dir' option and
AC_MACRODIR
environment variable. (He also coined the term
autoconfiscate to mean "adapt a software package to use
Autoconf".) Roland and Noah improved the quoting protection in
AC_DEFINE
and fixed many bugs, especially when I got sick of
dealing with portability problems from February through June, 1993.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
A long wish list for major features had accumulated, and the effect of
several years of patching by various people had left some residual
cruft. In April 1994, while working for Cygnus Support, I began a major
revision of Autoconf. I added most of the features of the Cygnus
configure
that Autoconf had lacked, largely by adapting the
relevant parts of Cygnus configure
with the help of david zuhn
and Ken Raeburn. These features include support for using
`config.sub', `config.guess', `--host', and
`--target'; making links to files; and running configure
scripts in subdirectories. Adding these features enabled Ken to convert
GNU as
, and Rob Savoye to convert DejaGNU, to using
Autoconf.
I added more features in response to other peoples' requests. Many
people had asked for configure
scripts to share the results of
the checks between runs, because (particularly when configuring a large
source tree, like Cygnus does) they were frustratingly slow. Mike
Haertel suggested adding site-specific initialization scripts. People
distributing software that had to unpack on MS-DOS asked for a way to
override the `.in' extension on the file names, which produced file
names like `config.h.in' containing two dots. Jim Avera did an
extensive examination of the problems with quoting in AC_DEFINE
and AC_SUBST
; his insights led to significant improvements.
Richard Stallman asked that compiler output be sent to `config.log'
instead of `/dev/null', to help people debug the Emacs
configure
script.
I made some other changes because of my dissatisfaction with the quality of the program. I made the messages showing results of the checks less ambiguous, always printing a result. I regularized the names of the macros and cleaned up coding style inconsistencies. I added some auxiliary utilities that I had developed to help convert source code packages to use Autoconf. With the help of Fran@,cois Pinard, I made the macros not interrupt each others' messages. (That feature revealed some performance bottlenecks in GNU M4, which he hastily corrected!) I reorganized the documentation around problems people want to solve. And I began a test suite, because experience had shown that Autoconf has a pronounced tendency to regress when we change it.
Again, several alpha testers gave invaluable feedback, especially Fran@,cois Pinard, Jim Meyering, Karl Berry, Rob Savoye, Ken Raeburn, and Mark Eichin.
Finally, version 2.0 was ready. And there was much rejoicing. (And I have free time again. I think. Yeah, right.)
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
A.1 GNU Free Documentation License License for copying this manual
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Copyright © 2000,2001,2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies of this license document, but changing it is not allowed. |
The purpose of this License is to make a manual, textbook, or other functional and useful document free in the sense of freedom: to assure everyone the effective freedom to copy and redistribute it, with or without modifying it, either commercially or noncommercially. Secondarily, this License preserves for the author and publisher a way to get credit for their work, while not being considered responsible for modifications made by others.
This License is a kind of "copyleft", which means that derivative works of the document must themselves be free in the same sense. It complements the GNU General Public License, which is a copyleft license designed for free software.
We have designed this License in order to use it for manuals for free software, because free software needs free documentation: a free program should come with manuals providing the same freedoms that the software does. But this License is not limited to software manuals; it can be used for any textual work, regardless of subject matter or whether it is published as a printed book. We recommend this License principally for works whose purpose is instruction or reference.
This License applies to any manual or other work, in any medium, that contains a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it can be distributed under the terms of this License. Such a notice grants a world-wide, royalty-free license, unlimited in duration, to use that work under the conditions stated herein. The "Document", below, refers to any such manual or work. Any member of the public is a licensee, and is addressed as "you". You accept the license if you copy, modify or distribute the work in a way requiring permission under copyright law.
A "Modified Version" of the Document means any work containing the Document or a portion of it, either copied verbatim, or with modifications and/or translated into another language.
A "Secondary Section" is a named appendix or a front-matter section of the Document that deals exclusively with the relationship of the publishers or authors of the Document to the Document's overall subject (or to related matters) and contains nothing that could fall directly within that overall subject. (Thus, if the Document is in part a textbook of mathematics, a Secondary Section may not explain any mathematics.) The relationship could be a matter of historical connection with the subject or with related matters, or of legal, commercial, philosophical, ethical or political position regarding them.
The "Invariant Sections" are certain Secondary Sections whose titles are designated, as being those of Invariant Sections, in the notice that says that the Document is released under this License. If a section does not fit the above definition of Secondary then it is not allowed to be designated as Invariant. The Document may contain zero Invariant Sections. If the Document does not identify any Invariant Sections then there are none.
The "Cover Texts" are certain short passages of text that are listed, as Front-Cover Texts or Back-Cover Texts, in the notice that says that the Document is released under this License. A Front-Cover Text may be at most 5 words, and a Back-Cover Text may be at most 25 words.
A "Transparent" copy of the Document means a machine-readable copy, represented in a format whose specification is available to the general public, that is suitable for revising the document straightforwardly with generic text editors or (for images composed of pixels) generic paint programs or (for drawings) some widely available drawing editor, and that is suitable for input to text formatters or for automatic translation to a variety of formats suitable for input to text formatters. A copy made in an otherwise Transparent file format whose markup, or absence of markup, has been arranged to thwart or discourage subsequent modification by readers is not Transparent. An image format is not Transparent if used for any substantial amount of text. A copy that is not "Transparent" is called "Opaque".
Examples of suitable formats for Transparent copies include plain ASCII without markup, Texinfo input format, LaTeX input format, SGML or XML using a publicly available DTD, and standard-conforming simple HTML, PostScript or PDF designed for human modification. Examples of transparent image formats include PNG, XCF and JPG. Opaque formats include proprietary formats that can be read and edited only by proprietary word processors, SGML or XML for which the DTD and/or processing tools are not generally available, and the machine-generated HTML, PostScript or PDF produced by some word processors for output purposes only.
The "Title Page" means, for a printed book, the title page itself, plus such following pages as are needed to hold, legibly, the material this License requires to appear in the title page. For works in formats which do not have any title page as such, "Title Page" means the text near the most prominent appearance of the work's title, preceding the beginning of the body of the text.
A section "Entitled XYZ" means a named subunit of the Document whose title either is precisely XYZ or contains XYZ in parentheses following text that translates XYZ in another language. (Here XYZ stands for a specific section name mentioned below, such as "Acknowledgements", "Dedications", "Endorsements", or "History".) To "Preserve the Title" of such a section when you modify the Document means that it remains a section "Entitled XYZ" according to this definition.
The Document may include Warranty Disclaimers next to the notice which states that this License applies to the Document. These Warranty Disclaimers are considered to be included by reference in this License, but only as regards disclaiming warranties: any other implication that these Warranty Disclaimers may have is void and has no effect on the meaning of this License.
You may copy and distribute the Document in any medium, either commercially or noncommercially, provided that this License, the copyright notices, and the license notice saying this License applies to the Document are reproduced in all copies, and that you add no other conditions whatsoever to those of this License. You may not use technical measures to obstruct or control the reading or further copying of the copies you make or distribute. However, you may accept compensation in exchange for copies. If you distribute a large enough number of copies you must also follow the conditions in section 3.
You may also lend copies, under the same conditions stated above, and you may publicly display copies.
If you publish printed copies (or copies in media that commonly have printed covers) of the Document, numbering more than 100, and the Document's license notice requires Cover Texts, you must enclose the copies in covers that carry, clearly and legibly, all these Cover Texts: Front-Cover Texts on the front cover, and Back-Cover Texts on the back cover. Both covers must also clearly and legibly identify you as the publisher of these copies. The front cover must present the full title with all words of the title equally prominent and visible. You may add other material on the covers in addition. Copying with changes limited to the covers, as long as they preserve the title of the Document and satisfy these conditions, can be treated as verbatim copying in other respects.
If the required texts for either cover are too voluminous to fit legibly, you should put the first ones listed (as many as fit reasonably) on the actual cover, and continue the rest onto adjacent pages.
If you publish or distribute Opaque copies of the Document numbering more than 100, you must either include a machine-readable Transparent copy along with each Opaque copy, or state in or with each Opaque copy a computer-network location from which the general network-using public has access to download using public-standard network protocols a complete Transparent copy of the Document, free of added material. If you use the latter option, you must take reasonably prudent steps, when you begin distribution of Opaque copies in quantity, to ensure that this Transparent copy will remain thus accessible at the stated location until at least one year after the last time you distribute an Opaque copy (directly or through your agents or retailers) of that edition to the public.
It is requested, but not required, that you contact the authors of the Document well before redistributing any large number of copies, to give them a chance to provide you with an updated version of the Document.
You may copy and distribute a Modified Version of the Document under the conditions of sections 2 and 3 above, provided that you release the Modified Version under precisely this License, with the Modified Version filling the role of the Document, thus licensing distribution and modification of the Modified Version to whoever possesses a copy of it. In addition, you must do these things in the Modified Version:
If the Modified Version includes new front-matter sections or appendices that qualify as Secondary Sections and contain no material copied from the Document, you may at your option designate some or all of these sections as invariant. To do this, add their titles to the list of Invariant Sections in the Modified Version's license notice. These titles must be distinct from any other section titles.
You may add a section Entitled "Endorsements", provided it contains nothing but endorsements of your Modified Version by various parties--for example, statements of peer review or that the text has been approved by an organization as the authoritative definition of a standard.
You may add a passage of up to five words as a Front-Cover Text, and a passage of up to 25 words as a Back-Cover Text, to the end of the list of Cover Texts in the Modified Version. Only one passage of Front-Cover Text and one of Back-Cover Text may be added by (or through arrangements made by) any one entity. If the Document already includes a cover text for the same cover, previously added by you or by arrangement made by the same entity you are acting on behalf of, you may not add another; but you may replace the old one, on explicit permission from the previous publisher that added the old one.
The author(s) and publisher(s) of the Document do not by this License give permission to use their names for publicity for or to assert or imply endorsement of any Modified Version.
You may combine the Document with other documents released under this License, under the terms defined in section 4 above for modified versions, provided that you include in the combination all of the Invariant Sections of all of the original documents, unmodified, and list them all as Invariant Sections of your combined work in its license notice, and that you preserve all their Warranty Disclaimers.
The combined work need only contain one copy of this License, and multiple identical Invariant Sections may be replaced with a single copy. If there are multiple Invariant Sections with the same name but different contents, make the title of each such section unique by adding at the end of it, in parentheses, the name of the original author or publisher of that section if known, or else a unique number. Make the same adjustment to the section titles in the list of Invariant Sections in the license notice of the combined work.
In the combination, you must combine any sections Entitled "History" in the various original documents, forming one section Entitled "History"; likewise combine any sections Entitled "Acknowledgements", and any sections Entitled "Dedications". You must delete all sections Entitled "Endorsements."
You may make a collection consisting of the Document and other documents released under this License, and replace the individual copies of this License in the various documents with a single copy that is included in the collection, provided that you follow the rules of this License for verbatim copying of each of the documents in all other respects.
You may extract a single document from such a collection, and distribute it individually under this License, provided you insert a copy of this License into the extracted document, and follow this License in all other respects regarding verbatim copying of that document.
A compilation of the Document or its derivatives with other separate and independent documents or works, in or on a volume of a storage or distribution medium, is called an "aggregate" if the copyright resulting from the compilation is not used to limit the legal rights of the compilation's users beyond what the individual works permit. When the Document is included an aggregate, this License does not apply to the other works in the aggregate which are not themselves derivative works of the Document.
If the Cover Text requirement of section 3 is applicable to these copies of the Document, then if the Document is less than one half of the entire aggregate, the Document's Cover Texts may be placed on covers that bracket the Document within the aggregate, or the electronic equivalent of covers if the Document is in electronic form. Otherwise they must appear on printed covers that bracket the whole aggregate.
Translation is considered a kind of modification, so you may distribute translations of the Document under the terms of section 4. Replacing Invariant Sections with translations requires special permission from their copyright holders, but you may include translations of some or all Invariant Sections in addition to the original versions of these Invariant Sections. You may include a translation of this License, and all the license notices in the Document, and any Warrany Disclaimers, provided that you also include the original English version of this License and the original versions of those notices and disclaimers. In case of a disagreement between the translation and the original version of this License or a notice or disclaimer, the original version will prevail.
If a section in the Document is Entitled "Acknowledgements", "Dedications", or "History", the requirement (section 4) to Preserve its Title (section 1) will typically require changing the actual title.
You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Document except as expressly provided for under this License. Any other attempt to copy, modify, sublicense or distribute the Document is void, and will automatically terminate your rights under this License. However, parties who have received copies, or rights, from you under this License will not have their licenses terminated so long as such parties remain in full compliance.
The Free Software Foundation may publish new, revised versions of the GNU Free Documentation License from time to time. Such new versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to address new problems or concerns. See http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/.
Each version of the License is given a distinguishing version number. If the Document specifies that a particular numbered version of this License "or any later version" applies to it, you have the option of following the terms and conditions either of that specified version or of any later version that has been published (not as a draft) by the Free Software Foundation. If the Document does not specify a version number of this License, you may choose any version ever published (not as a draft) by the Free Software Foundation.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
To use this License in a document you have written, include a copy of the License in the document and put the following copyright and license notices just after the title page:
Copyright (C) year your name. Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''. |
If you have Invariant Sections, Front-Cover Texts and Back-Cover Texts, replace the "with...Texts." line with this:
with the Invariant Sections being list their titles, with the Front-Cover Texts being list, and with the Back-Cover Texts being list. |
If you have Invariant Sections without Cover Texts, or some other combination of the three, merge those two alternatives to suit the situation.
If your document contains nontrivial examples of program code, we recommend releasing these examples in parallel under your choice of free software license, such as the GNU General Public License, to permit their use in free software.
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
B.1 Environment Variable Index Index of environment variables used B.2 Output Variable Index Index of variables set in output files B.3 Preprocessor Symbol Index Index of C preprocessor symbols defined B.4 Autoconf Macro Index Index of Autoconf macros B.5 M4 Macro Index Index of M4, M4sugar, and M4sh macros B.6 Autotest Macro Index Index of Autotest macros B.7 Program and Function Index Index of those with portability problems B.8 Concept Index General index
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
This is an alphabetical list of the environment variables that Autoconf checks.
Jump to: | C E I L M N P R S W |
---|
Jump to: | C E I L M N P R S W |
---|
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
This is an alphabetical list of the variables that Autoconf can substitute into files that it creates, typically one or more `Makefile's. See section 7.2 Setting Output Variables, for more information on how this is done.
Jump to: | A B C D E F G H I K L M N O P R S T U X Y |
---|
Jump to: | A B C D E F G H I K L M N O P R S T U X Y |
---|
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
This is an alphabetical list of the C preprocessor symbols that the
Autoconf macros define. To work with Autoconf, C source code needs to
use these names in #if
directives.
Jump to: | _
C D F G H I L M N O P R S T U V W X Y |
---|
Jump to: | _
C D F G H I L M N O P R S T U V W X Y |
---|
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
This is an alphabetical list of the Autoconf macros. To make the list easier to use, the macros are listed without their preceding `AC_'.
Jump to: | A B C D E F G H I L M O P R S T U V W X Y |
---|
Jump to: | A B C D E F G H I L M O P R S T U V W X Y |
---|
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
This is an alphabetical list of the M4, M4sugar, and M4sh macros. To make the list easier to use, the macros are listed without their preceding `m4_' or `AS_'.
Jump to: | B D M P Q U |
---|
Jump to: | B D M P Q U |
---|
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
This is an alphabetical list of the Autotest macros. To make the list easier to use, the macros are listed without their preceding `AT_'.
Jump to: | C D I K S T |
---|
Jump to: | C D I K S T |
---|
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
This is an alphabetical list of the programs and functions which portability is discussed in this document.
Jump to: | !
.
/
A B C D E F G I L M P R S T U V |
---|
Jump to: | !
.
/
A B C D E F G I L M P R S T U V |
---|
[ < ] | [ > ] | [ << ] | [ Up ] | [ >> ] | [Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
This is an alphabetical list of the files, tools, and concepts introduced in this document.
Jump to: | "
$
@
_
`
A B C D E F H I L M O P Q R S T U V Z |
---|
Jump to: | "
$
@
_
`
A B C D E F H I L M O P Q R S T U V Z |
---|
[Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
GNU Autoconf, Automake and Libtool, by G. V. Vaughan, B. Elliston, T. Tromey, and I. L. Taylor. New Riders, 2000, ISBN 1578701902.
Using
defn
.
Yet another great name from Lars J. Aas.
Yet another reason why assigning LIBOBJS
directly is discouraged.
When a failure occurs, the test suite is rerun, verbosely, and the user is asked to "play" with this failure to provide better information. It is important to keep the same environment between the first run, and bug-tracking runs.
[Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
1. Introduction
2. The GNU Build System
2.1 Automake3. Making
2.2 Libtool
2.3 Pointers
configure
Scripts
3.1 Writing `configure.ac'4. Initialization and Output Files
3.1.1 A Shell Script Compiler3.2 Using
3.1.2 The Autoconf Language
3.1.3 Standard `configure.ac' Layout
autoscan
to Create `configure.ac'
3.3 Usingifnames
to List Conditionals
3.4 Usingautoconf
to Createconfigure
3.5 Usingautoreconf
to Updateconfigure
Scripts
4.1 Initializing5. Existing Testsconfigure
4.2 Notices inconfigure
4.3 Findingconfigure
Input
4.4 Outputting Files
4.5 Performing Configuration Actions
4.6 Creating Configuration Files
4.7 Substitutions in Makefiles
4.7.1 Preset Output Variables4.8 Configuration Header Files
4.7.2 Installation Directory Variables
4.7.3 Build Directories
4.7.4 Automatic Remaking
4.8.1 Configuration Header Templates4.9 Running Arbitrary Configuration Commands
4.8.2 Usingautoheader
to Create `config.h.in'
4.8.3 Autoheader Macros
4.10 Creating Configuration Links
4.11 Configuring Other Packages in Subdirectories
4.12 Default Prefix
5.1 Common Behavior6. Writing Tests
5.1.1 Standard Symbols5.2 Alternative Programs
5.1.2 Default Includes
5.2.1 Particular Program Checks5.3 Files
5.2.2 Generic Program and File Checks
5.4 Library Files
5.5 Library Functions
5.5.1 Portability of C Functions5.6 Header Files
5.5.2 Particular Function Checks
5.5.3 Generic Function Checks
5.6.1 Portability of Headers5.7 Declarations
5.6.2 Particular Header Checks
5.6.3 Generic Header Checks
5.7.1 Particular Declaration Checks5.8 Structures
5.7.2 Generic Declaration Checks
5.8.1 Particular Structure Checks5.9 Types
5.8.2 Generic Structure Checks
5.9.1 Particular Type Checks5.10 Compilers and Preprocessors
5.9.2 Generic Type Checks
5.10.1 Specific Compiler Characteristics5.11 System Services
5.10.2 Generic Compiler Characteristics
5.10.3 C Compiler Characteristics
5.10.4 C++ Compiler Characteristics
5.10.5 Fortran 77 Compiler Characteristics
5.12 UNIX Variants
6.1 Language Choice7. Results of Tests
6.2 Writing Test Programs
6.2.1 Guidelines for Test Programs6.3 Running the Preprocessor
6.2.2 Test Functions
6.2.3 Generating Sources
6.4 Running the Compiler
6.5 Running the Linker
6.6 Checking Run Time Behavior
6.7 Systemology
6.8 Multiple Cases
7.1 Defining C Preprocessor Symbols8. Programming in M4
7.2 Setting Output Variables
7.3 Caching Results
7.3.1 Cache Variable Names7.4 Printing Messages
7.3.2 Cache Files
7.3.3 Cache Checkpointing
8.1 M4 Quotation9. Writing Autoconf Macros
8.1.1 Active Characters8.2 Using
8.1.2 One Macro Call
8.1.3 Quotation and Nested Macros
8.1.4changequote
is Evil
8.1.5 Quadrigraphs
8.1.6 Quotation Rule Of Thumb
autom4te
8.2.1 Invoking8.3 Programming in M4sugarautom4te
8.2.2 Customizingautom4te
8.3.1 Redefined M4 Macros8.4 Programming in M4sh
8.3.2 Evaluation Macros
8.3.3 Forbidden Patterns
9.1 Macro Definitions10. Portable Shell Programming
9.2 Macro Names
9.3 Reporting Messages
9.4 Dependencies Between Macros
9.4.1 Prerequisite Macros9.5 Obsoleting Macros
9.4.2 Suggested Ordering
9.6 Coding Style
10.1 Shellology11. Manual Configuration
10.2 Here-Documents
10.3 File Descriptors
10.4 File System Conventions
10.5 Shell Substitutions
10.6 Assignments
10.7 Special Shell Variables
10.8 Limitations of Shell Builtins
10.9 Limitations of Usual Tools
10.10 Limitations of Make
11.1 Specifying the System Type12. Site Configuration
11.2 Getting the Canonical System Type
11.3 Using the System Type
12.1 Working With External Software13. Running
12.2 Choosing Package Options
12.3 Making Your Help Strings Look Pretty
12.4 Configuring Site Details
12.5 Transforming Program Names When Installing
12.5.1 Transformation Options12.6 Setting Site Defaults
12.5.2 Transformation Examples
12.5.3 Transformation Rules
configure
Scripts
13.1 Basic Installation14. Recreating a Configuration
13.2 Compilers and Options
13.3 Compiling For Multiple Architectures
13.4 Installation Names
13.5 Optional Features
13.6 Specifying the System Type
13.7 Sharing Defaults
13.8 Defining Variables
13.9configure
Invocation
15. Obsolete Constructs
15.1 Obsolete `config.status' Invocation16. Generating Test Suites with Autotest
15.2 `acconfig.h'
15.3 Usingautoupdate
to Modernize `configure.ac'
15.4 Obsolete Macros
15.5 Upgrading From Version 1
15.5.1 Changed File Names15.6 Upgrading From Version 2.13
15.5.2 Changed Makefiles
15.5.3 Changed Macros
15.5.4 Changed Results
15.5.5 Changed Macro Writing
15.6.1 Changed Quotation
15.6.2 New Macros
15.6.3 Hosts and Cross-Compilation
15.6.4AC_LIBOBJ
vs.LIBOBJS
15.6.5AC_FOO_IFELSE
vs.AC_TRY_FOO
16.1 Using an Autotest Test Suite17. Frequent Autoconf Questions, with answers
16.1.116.2 Writing `testsuite.at'testsuite
Scripts
16.1.2 Autotest Logs
16.3 Runningtestsuite
Scripts
16.4 Makingtestsuite
Scripts
17.1 Distributing18. History of Autoconfconfigure
Scripts
17.2 Why Require GNU M4?
17.3 How Can I Bootstrap?
17.4 Why Not Imake?
17.5 How Do I#define
Installation Directories?
17.6 What is `autom4te.cache'?
18.1 GenesisA. Copying This Manual
18.2 Exodus
18.3 Leviticus
18.4 Numbers
18.5 Deuteronomy
A.1 GNU Free Documentation LicenseB. Indices
A.1.1 ADDENDUM: How to use this License for your documents
B.1 Environment Variable Index
B.2 Output Variable Index
B.3 Preprocessor Symbol Index
B.4 Autoconf Macro Index
B.5 M4 Macro Index
B.6 Autotest Macro Index
B.7 Program and Function Index
B.8 Concept Index
[Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
1. Introduction
2. The GNU Build System
3. Makingconfigure
Scripts
4. Initialization and Output Files
5. Existing Tests
6. Writing Tests
7. Results of Tests
8. Programming in M4
9. Writing Autoconf Macros
10. Portable Shell Programming
11. Manual Configuration
12. Site Configuration
13. Runningconfigure
Scripts
14. Recreating a Configuration
15. Obsolete Constructs
16. Generating Test Suites with Autotest
17. Frequent Autoconf Questions, with answers
18. History of Autoconf
A. Copying This Manual
B. Indices
[Top] | [Contents] | [Index] | [ ? ] |
Button | Name | Go to | From 1.2.3 go to |
---|---|---|---|
[ < ] | Back | previous section in reading order | 1.2.2 |
[ > ] | Forward | next section in reading order | 1.2.4 |
[ << ] | FastBack | previous or up-and-previous section | 1.1 |
[ Up ] | Up | up section | 1.2 |
[ >> ] | FastForward | next or up-and-next section | 1.3 |
[Top] | Top | cover (top) of document | |
[Contents] | Contents | table of contents | |
[Index] | Index | concept index | |
[ ? ] | About | this page |